Nissan PDF
Nissan PDF
Nissan PDF
Foreword
D23A131129-CA59C8CB-C9EB-42C4-B504-F8AF8A73B8DE
This manual was prepared to help you under- When reading the manual cause minor or moderate personal injury or
D23A131129-B1BE6CF6-22AD-4020-A43D-3E1D2A7455D1
stand the operation and maintenance of your damages to your vehicle. To avoid or reduce
This manual includes information for all options
vehicle so that you may enjoy many kilometers the risk, the procedures must be followed
available on this model. Therefore, you may find
(miles) of driving pleasure. Please read through carefully.
some information that does not apply to your
this manual before operating your vehicle. vehicle.
A separate Warranty Information & Mainte- Throughout this manual, some illustrations
nance Booklet explains details about the war- may only show the layout for Right-Hand Drive
ranties covering your vehicle. (RHD) models. For Left-Hand Drive (LHD) mod-
Your NISSAN dealer knows your vehicle best. els, the illustrated shape and location of some
When you require any service or have any components may differ.
questions, we will be glad to assist you with All information, specifications and illustrations
the extensive resources available for you. in this manual are those in effect at the time of
printing. NISSAN reserves the right to change
IMPORTANT SAFETY INFORMATION
D23A131129-E20DF1AA-22BC-47CB-B7D0-017CE6DFFFB7 specifications or designs without notice and
Reminders for safety! without obligation.
D23A131129-91D0EA2F-7DA9-46D7-92EF-017C6F603E88 SIC0697
Follow these important driving rules to help MODIFICATION OF YOUR VEHICLE
D23A131129-EF203BB2-ABA2-4612-8FCA-0ACC5C3CE29E If you see this symbol, it means “Do not do this”
ensure a safe and complete trip for you and This vehicle should not be modified. Modifica-
your passengers! or “Do not let this happen”.
tion could affect its performance, safety or
. NEVER drive under the influence of alco- durability, and may even violate governmental NOS1274
hol or drugs. regulations. In addition, damage or perfor-
. ALWAYS observe posted speed limits and mance problems resulting from modifications If you see a symbol similar to these in an
never drive too fast for conditions. may not be covered under NISSAN warranties. illustration, it means the arrow points to the
. ALWAYS use your seat belts and appro- front of the vehicle.
priate child restraint systems. Preteen Read firstD23A131129-0E4A92DE-D1FE-4675-BF47-F7633898A4C8
— then drive safely
children should be seated in the rear seat Before driving your vehicle, read this Owner’s NOS1275
(if equipped). Manual carefully. This will ensure familiarity
. ALWAYS provide information about the with controls and maintenance requirements, Arrows in an illustration that are similar to
proper use of vehicle safety features to assisting you in the safe operation of your these indicate movement or action.
all occupants of the vehicle. vehicle.
. ALWAYS review this Owner’s Manual for Throughout this manual we have used the NOS1276
important safety information. symbol followed by the word WARNING.
This is used to indicate the presence of a Arrows in an illustration that are similar to
hazard that could cause death or serious these call attention to an item in the illustra-
personal injury. To avoid or reduce the risk, tion.
the procedures must be followed precisely.
The symbol followed by the word CAU-
TION is also used throughout this manual to
indicate the presence of a hazard that could
JVC0871X
1. Child restraint anchor point* (for top 8. Supplemental side-impact air bags*
tether strap child restraint) (Page 1-17) (P.1-25)
2. Head restraints (P. 1-6) 9. Pre-tensioner seat belt system* (P.1-34)
3. Seat belts (P.1-8) 10. Front seats (P.1-2)
4. Supplemental curtain side-impact air 11. Supplemental driver’s knee air bag*
bags* (P.1-25) (P.1-25)
5. Supplemental front-impact air bags* *: if equipped
(P.1-25)
6. ISOFIX child restraint system* (P.1-16)
7. Rear seats* (P.1-5) or Jump seat* (P.1-6)
EXTERIOR FRONT
D23A131129-A7D731C2-C58B-4FEB-B117-40A4E0B39DA1
11. Tires
— Tires and wheels (P.8-32)
— Flat tire (P.6-2)
— Specifications (P.9-7)
— Four-Wheel Drive (4WD)*1 (P.5-17)
12. Side turn signal lights (fender or outside
rearview mirror)
— Bulb replacement (P.8-26)
13. Outside rearview mirrors (P.3-24)
14. Side view camera*1 (P.4-13)
15. Doors
— Keys (P.3-2)
— Door locks (P.3-4)
— Remote keyless entry system*1 (P.3-6)
— Intelligent Key system*1 (P.3-7)
— Security system*1 (P.3-15)
16. Child safety rear door locks*1 (P.3-5)
*1: if equipped
*2: The layout illustrated is for the Right-
Hand Drive (RHD) model. On the Left-Hand
Drive (LHD) model, the towing hook is
located on the opposite side.
JVC1015X
EXTERIOR REAR
D23A131129-74D041B7-1D60-49AD-9DE5-35CDEE6972C8
pines)
: For Sportech models (for Thailand) and
SPORT EDITION models (for Philippines)
*: if equipped
JVC0870X
PASSENGER COMPARTMENT
D23A131129-3236BBA8-79B0-4858-9BB8-AC2BFDEC1572
— Power door lock switch (driver’s door)*
(P.3-5)
— Outside rearview mirror remote control
switch (driver’s door)* (P.3-24)
*: if equipped
**: See the separate NissanConnect Owner’s
Manual (if equipped).
JVC0771X
COCKPIT
D23A131129-1B613D6A-4853-4100-88F1-87CBA0869EC0
— Audio control steering switch* (P.4-75
LEFT-HAND DRIVE (LHD) MODEL or **)
GUID-A297B8CA-B368-4153-89A1-481E044D636A
— Vehicle information display control
switch* (P.2-25)
8. Wiper and washer switch (P.2-37)
9. Steering-wheel-mounted controls* (right
side)
— Cruise control system* (P.5-26)
— Hands-Free Phone System switch*
(P.4-77, P.4-83 or **)
— Voice recognition system switch**
10. Shift lever
— Automatic Transmission (AT) (P.5-14)
— Manual Transmission (MT) (P.5-17)
11. Vehicle Dynamic Control (VDC) OFF
switch* (P.5-23)
12. Fuel-filler lid opener switch* (P.3-17)
13. Tilting steering wheel lever* (P.3-23)
*: if equipped
**: See the separate NissanConnect Owner’s
Manual (if equipped).
JVC0781X
1. Cup holder (P.2-44) 5. Headlight, fog light and turn signal switch
2. Instrument brightness control switch — Headlight (P.2-33)
(models with color display) (P.2-10) — Turn signal (P.2-35)
3. TRIP/RESET switch for twin trip odometer — Fog light* (P.2-36)
(models with color display) (P.2-8)
6. TRIP/RESET switch for twin trip odometer
4. Instrument brightness control switch (P.2-8)/Trip computer mode switch (mod-
(P.2-10)/Trip computer mode switch els without color display) (P.2-31 )
(models without color display) (P.2-31)
7. Steering-wheel-mounted controls* (left
side)
RIGHT-HAND DRIVE (RHD) MODEL 6. Headlight, fog light and turn signal switch
D23A131129-62FCC69C-B9E2-41E6-88D8-4600F2449E75 — Headlight (P.2-33)
— Turn signal (P.2-35)
— Fog light* (P.2-36)
7. TRIP/RESET switch for twin trip odometer
(P.2-8)/Trip computer mode switch (mod-
els without color display) (P.2-31)
8. TRIP/RESET switch for twin trip odometer
(models with color display) (P.2-8)
9. Instrument brightness control switch
(models with color display) (P.2-10)
10. Cup holder* (P.2-44)
11. Cup holder (for front bench seat models)
(P.2-44)
12. Tilting steering wheel lever* (P.3-23)
13. Auto slide back window switch* (P.2-41)
14. Fuel-filler lid opener switch* (P.3-17)
15. Vehicle Dynamic Control (VDC) OFF
switch* (P.5-23)
16. Headlight aiming control switch* (P.2-34)
*: if equipped
**: See the separate NissanConnect Owner’s
Manual (if equipped).
JVC0782X
INSTRUMENT PANEL
D23A131129-E7E5A3F7-B385-4AC2-8157-2543504FD64C
— Driver’s supplemental front-impact air
LEFT-HAND DRIVE (LHD) MODEL bag* (P.1-25)
D23A131129-6D48DE5E-E6B8-4E05-9494-9A537802FFED
— Power steering (P.5-34)
10. Ignition switch (models without Intelligent
Key system) (P.5-9)
11. Parking brake
— Operation (P.3-25)
— Check (P.8-15)
12. Hill descent control switch* (P.5-25)
13. Cargo light switch* (P.2-37)
14. Differential lock mode switch* (P.5-23)
15. USB (Universal Serial Bus) connection
port/iPod connection port (P.4-74 or **)
— Auxiliary (AUX) input jack (P.4-75 or **)
16. Four-Wheel Drive (4WD) mode switch*
(P.5-17)
17. Heater and air conditioner control (P.4-21)
18. Glove box (P.2-44)
— Fuse box (P.8-25)
19. Side ventilator (P.4-20)
: 4WD models
: 2WD models
*: if equipped
**: See the separate NissanConnect Owner’s
JVC0919X
Manual (if equipped).
RIGHT-HAND DRIVE (RHD) MODEL 11. Heater* and air conditioner control
D23A131129-5D9F835B-1CCC-4710-93BC-EB5FC79176F2 (P.4-21)
12. Heated seat switch* (P.1-5)
13. Diesel Particulate Filter (DPF) regeneration
switch* (P.5-5)
14. Parking sensor (sonar) system off switch*
(P.5-31)
15. Heated seat switch* (P.1-5) or Diesel Parti-
culate Filter (DPF) regeneration switch*
(P.5-5) or Cargo light switch* (P.2-37)
16. Hill descent control switch* (P.5-25)
17. Differential lock mode switch* (P.5-23)
18. Parking brake
— Operation (P.3-25)
— Check (P.8-15)
19. USB (Universal Serial Bus) connection
port/iPod connection port* (P.4-74 or ***)
— Auxiliary (AUX) input jack* (P.4-75 or ***)
20. Four-Wheel Drive (4WD) mode switch*
(P.5-17)
21. Steering wheel
— Horn (P.2-39)
— Driver’s supplemental front-impact air
bag* (P.1-25)
— Power steering (P.5-34)
JVC1017X
22. Hood release handle (P.3-16)
1. Front passenger’s supplemental front- — Around View Monitor* (P.4-13) 23. Ignition switch (models without Intelligent
impact air bag* (P.1-25) 7. Push-button ignition switch (models with Key system) (P.5-9)
2. Center ventilator (P.4-20) Intelligent Key system) (P.5-10) : 4WD models
3. Hazard indicator flasher switch (P.6-2) 8. Meters and gauges (P.2-7) : 2WD models
4. Power outlet (P.2-42) — Vehicle information display (P.2-20, : Except for front bench seat models
5. Rear seat belt warning light* (P.2-17) P.2-30) : For front bench seat models
6. Audio system* (P.4-31 or ***) or Navigation 9. Side ventilator (P.4-20) *: if equipped
system** or *** 10. Glove box (P.2-44) **: See the separate Navigation System
— Rear view monitor* (P.4-7) — Fuse box (P.8-25) Owner’s Manual (if equipped).
JVC0689X
ENGINE COMPARTMENT
D23A131129-A6D90333-9F08-48B9-AB33-7AA9C73BD806
QR25DE ENGINE
GUID-5C84E963-AB0B-4575-908E-4D9D22743A03
JVC0772X
JVC0665X
YS23DDT/DDTT ENGINE
GUID-86AFFD37-354E-418D-96F7-AD1371D4CA3F
JVC0773X
SEATS
D23A131129-AF9D401E-0B20-43D9-8346-3BA2A7395517
Manual seat adjustment (if equipped)
D23A131129-C387F95D-BF50-4181-A1DE-A3A10A7A6EE4
WARNING:
After adjusting a seat, gently shake the seat
to confirm that the seat is locked securely. If
the seat is not locked securely, it may move
suddenly and could cause the loss of control
of the vehicle.
SSS0133A
JVR0392X
JVR0054X
1. Start the engine. . When cleaning the seat, never use gaso-
2. Select heat range. line, thinner, or any similar materials.
. For high heat, push the HI (High) side of . If any malfunctions are found or the
the switch . heated seat does not operate, turn the
. For low heat, push the LO (Low) side of switch off and have the system checked
by a NISSAN dealer.
the switch .
. The indicator light will illuminate when REAR SEATS (Double Cab model)
the heater is on. D23A131129-AD535E72-1A82-44E4-9DCB-9DB425F1BD66
SSS1038
SSS0997
SSS1035
SEAT BELTS
D23A131129-E14362D8-0956-4A90-AA28-730EEA28AE4F
Make sure the head restraint is positioned from
the stored position or any non-latch position so PRECAUTIONS ON SEAT BELT USAGE
D23A131129-18940EF4-D22E-4D9C-A922-1F3396A16D5E
the lock knob is engaged in the notch before If you are wearing the seat belt properly
riding in that designated seating position. adjusted and sitting upright and well back in
the seat, chances of being injured or killed in an
Lower D23A131129-62531C41-6946-4AC1-A69A-618CE8CF1A92 accident and/or the severity of injury may be
greatly reduced. NISSAN strongly encourages
you and all of your passengers to buckle up
every time you drive, even if your seating
position includes the supplemental air bag
systems.
SSS1036
WARNING:
. Seatbelts are designed to bear upon the
bony structure of the body, and should be
worn low across the front of the pelvis or
the pelvis, chest and shoulders, as applic-
able; wearing the lap section of the belt
across the abdominal area must be
avoided. Serious injury may occur if a
seat belt is not worn properly.
. Position the lap belt as low and snug as
SSS0134A
possible around the hips, not the waist. A
lap belt worn too high could increase the
risk of internal injuries in an accident.
. Do not allow more than one person to use
the same seat belt. Each belt assembly
must only be used by one occupant; it is
dangerous to put a belt around a child
being carried on the occupant’s lap.
. Never carry more people in the vehicle
than there are seat belts.
. Never wear seat belts inside out. Belts
should not be worn with straps twisted.
SSS0136A Doing so may reduce their effectiveness.
. Seatbelts should be adjusted as firmly as
possible, consistent with comfort, to pro-
vide the protection for which they have
been designed. A slack belt will greatly
reduce the protection afforded to the
wearer.
. Every person who drives or rides in this
vehicle should use a seat belt at all times.
Children should be properly restrained in
the rear seat (if equipped) and, if appro-
priate, in a child restraint system.
SSS0014 SSS0016 . Do not put the belt behind your back or
under your arm. Always route the
shoulder belt over your shoulder and
across your chest. The belt should be
away from your face and neck, but not dealer. Large children
D23A131129-E7E81196-1AD1-4467-B945-35A94DE2AE24
falling off your shoulder. Serious injury CHILD SAFETY
may occur if a seat belt is not worn D23A131129-391C4AD6-2F06-4205-BE55-366EA6C5E424
WARNING:
properly.
WARNING: . Never allow children to stand or kneel on
. No modifications or additions should be
made by the user which will either pre- . Infants and children need special protec- any seats.
vent the seat belt adjusting devices from tion. The vehicle’s seat belts may not fit . Never allow children in the luggage areas
operating to remove slack, or prevent the them properly. The shoulder belt may while the vehicle is moving. A child could
seat belt assembly from being adjusted come too close to the face or neck. The be seriously injured in an accident or
to remove slack. lap belt may not fit over their small sudden stop.
hipbones. In an accident, an improperly
. Care should be taken to avoid contam- Children who are too large for a child restraint
fitted seat belt could cause serious or
ination of the webbing with polishes, oils system should be seated and restrained by the
fatal injury.
and chemicals, and particularly battery seat belts that are provided.
acid. Cleaning may safely be carried out . Always use an appropriate child restraint
using mild soap and water. The belt system. If the child’s seating position has a shoulder
should be replaced if webbing becomes belt that fits close to the face or neck, the use
Children need adults to help protect them. of a booster seat (commercially available) may
frayed, contaminated or damaged.
They need to be properly restrained. The help overcome this. The booster seat should
. It is essential to replace the entire as- proper restraint depends on the child’s size. raise the child so that the shoulder belt is
sembly after it has been worn in a severe properly positioned across the top, middle
impact even if damage to the assembly is Infants and small children
D23A131129-E94847D1-6A40-4650-955B-125C3ECA7686 portion of the shoulder and the lap belt is low
not obvious. on the hips. The booster seat should also fit the
. All seat belt assemblies including retrac- vehicle seat. Once the child has grown so that
tors and attaching hardware should be the shoulder belt is no longer on or near the
inspected after any collision by a NISSAN face or neck of the child, use the shoulder belt
dealer. NISSAN recommends that all seat without the booster seat. In addition, there are
belt assemblies in use during a collision many types of child restraint systems available
be replaced unless the collision was for larger children that should be used for
minor and the belts show no damage maximum protection.
and continue to operate properly. Seat
belt assemblies not in use during a PREGNANT WOMEN
D23A131129-AEA253B0-0EB2-45A3-8A7C-77A6C8748C8C
collision should also be inspected and, NISSAN recommends that pregnant women
when necessary, replaced if either da- SSS0099 use seat belts. The seat belt should be worn
mage or improper operation is noted. snug, and always position the lap belt as low as
. Once the pre-tensioner seat belt (if NISSAN recommends that infants and small possible around the hips, not the waist. Place
equipped) has activated, it cannot be children be seated in a child restraint system. the shoulder belt over your shoulder and
reused. It must be replaced together with You should choose a child restraint system that across your chest. Never run the lap/shoulder
the retractor. Contact a NISSAN dealer. fits your vehicle and the child, and always belt over your abdominal area. Contact your
follow the manufacturer’s instructions for in- doctor for specific recommendations.
. Removal and installation of the pre-ten-
stallation and use.
sioner seat belt system (if equipped)
components should be done by a NISSAN
1-10 Safety — seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system
INJUREDD23A131129-B729A0D8-0A5A-472D-84AA-4609C350F628
PERSONS THREE-POINT TYPE SEAT BELTS
D23A131129-3EB40FFA-D110-4A7F-B53A-87C147539DB9
NISSAN recommends that injured persons use
seat belts. Contact your doctor for specific
FasteningD23A131129-391FCFD2-B3B9-4010-9B4D-878A71128608
seat belts
recommendations.
SelectingD23A131129-FF5C1257-8A87-435E-A0D4-327B0293ED80
correct set of seat belts
SSS0467
tiveness of the entire restraint system TWO-POINT TYPE SEAT BELTS (if 2. Adjust the seat belt length. To shorten, hold
and increase the chance or severity of equipped) GUID-62240B1A-50FF-480E-9F1B-BA1128DD3E91 the tongue and pull the upper belt as
injury in an accident. illustrated . To lengthen, hold the tongue
. The shoulder belt should rest on the Fastening seat belts and pull the under belt as illustrated .
GUID-9D5491FC-4CDF-4278-B294-097F2969E29A
middle of the shoulder. It must not rest
against the neck. WARNING:
. Be sure that the seat belt is not twisted in Every person who drives or rides in this
any way. vehicle should use a seat belt at all times.
. Be sure that the shoulder belt anchor is
secured by trying to move the shoulder
belt anchor up and down after adjust-
ment.
To adjust, pull in the release button and
move the shoulder belt anchor to the proper
position , so that the belt passes over the SSS0450
center of the shoulder. The belt should be away
from your face and neck, but not falling off your 3. Position the lap belt portion low and snug
shoulder. Release the button to lock the on the hips as shown.
shoulder belt anchor into position.
UnfasteningGUID-58DDFB9C-2329-474B-A774-0BA343F15799
seat belts
Unfastening seat belts
D23A131129-40FD8093-1590-4D59-83F0-2E67047746BC
SSS0448
Push the button on the buckle.
Push the button on the buckle. The seat belt 1. Insert the tongue into the buckle marked
automatically retracts. CENTER until you hear and feel the latch SEAT BELT MAINTENANCE
D23A131129-6BF4BB35-1E1E-49F1-ADEA-CFFF4CD99C75
engage. Periodically check that the seat belt and all the
Checking seat belt operation
D23A131129-B794C01F-AA78-4BD9-BB79-DDC7CF7793DF metal components, such as buckles, tongues,
Seat belt retractors are designed to lock seat retractors, flexible wires and anchors, work
belt movement: properly. If loose parts, deterioration, cuts or
. When the seat belt is pulled quickly from other damage on the seat belt webbing is
the retractor. found, the entire seat belt assembly should be
replaced.
. When the vehicle slows down rapidly.
To increase your confidence in the seat belts, If dirt builds up in the shoulder belt guide of the
check the operation by grasping the shoulder seat belt anchors, the seat belts may retract
belt and pulling forward quickly. The retractor slowly. Wipe the shoulder belt guide with a
should lock and restrict further belt movement. clean, dry cloth.
If the retractor does not lock during this check, To clean the seat belt webbing, apply a mild
contact a NISSAN dealer immediately. SSS0541 soap solution or any solution recommended
for cleaning upholstery or carpet. Then wipe
with a cloth and allow the seat belts to dry in
the shade. Do not allow the seat belts to retract
CHILD RESTRAINTS
D23A131129-13C5E90E-D7AE-4922-9F00-D9E6EAF19D7E
until they are completely dry. PRECAUTIONS ON CHILD RESTRAINT . Child restraint systems specially de-
signed for infants and small children are
USAGE D23A131129-E1FB12A0-C2B8-4595-A074-B4658FD76E0A available from several manufacturers.
When selecting any child restraint sys-
tems, place your child in the child re-
straint system and check the various
adjustments to be sure that the child
restraint system is compatible with your
child. Always follow the manufacturer’s
instructions for installation and use.
. NISSAN recommends that the child re-
straints be installed in the rear seat
(Double Cab model). According to acci-
dent statistics, children are safer when
SSS0099 properly restrained in the rear seat than
in the front seat.
WARNING: . Follow all of the child restraint manufac-
turer’s instructions for installation and
. Infants and small children should never use. When purchasing a child restraint, be
be carried on your lap. It is not possible sure to select one which will fit your child
for even the strongest adult to resist the and vehicle. It may not be possible to
forces of a severe accident. The child properly install some types of child re-
could be crushed between the adult and straint in your vehicle.
parts of the vehicle. Also, do not put the . The direction of the child restraint, either
same seat belt around both your child front-facing or rear-facing, depends on
and yourself. the type of the child restraint and the size
. Infants and children need special protec- of the child. Refer to the child restraint
tion. The vehicle’s seat belts may not fit manufacturer’s instructions for details.
them properly. The shoulder belt may . For a front-facing child restraint system,
come too close to the face or neck. The check to make sure the shoulder belt
lap belt may not fit over their small hip does not fit close to child’s face or neck. If
bones. In an accident, an improperly it does, put the shoulder belt behind the
fitting seat belt could cause serious or child restraint system. If you must install
fatal injury. a front-facing child restraint system in
. Infants and small children should always the front seat, see “Installation on front
be placed in an appropriate child re- passenger’s seat” (P.1-22).
straint while riding in the vehicle. Failure . Never install a rear-facing child restraint
to use a child restraint can result in on the front passenger’s seat when the
serious injury or death. front passenger’s air bag is available.
Supplemental front-impact air bags in-
flate with great force. A rear-facing child accident. UNIVERSAL CHILD RESTRAINTS FOR
restraint could be struck by the supple- . Always use an appropriate child restraint FRONT SEAT AND REAR SEATS (Double
mental front-impact air bags in an acci- system. An improperly installed child
dent and could seriously injure or kill your Cab models)GUID-AD37682E-F92E-48CA-8FD0-942D361FB6DA
restraint system could lead to serious
child. injury or death in an accident. NOTE:
. Do not install a child restraint in the jump . When the child restraint is not in use, Universal child restraints approved to UN
seats (if equipped for King Cab model). keep it secured with the ISOFIX child Regulation NO. 44 (UN R44) or UN Regulation
These seats are not suitable for child restraint system (if equipped) or a seat NO. 129 (UN R129) are clearly marked “Uni-
restraint installation. belt to prevent it from being thrown versal”.
. Adjustable seatbacks should be posi- around in case of a sudden stop or When selecting any child restraint, keep the
tioned to ensure full contact between accident. following points in mind:
child restraint and seatback.
NISSAN recommends that infants and small . Choose a child restraint that complies with
. If the seat belt in the position where a children be seated in a child restraint system. UN R44 or UN R129.
child restraint is installed requires a lock- You should choose a child restraint system that . Place your child in the child restraint and
ing device and if it is not used, injuries fits your vehicle and always follow the manu- check the various adjustments to be sure
could result from a child restraint system facturer’s instructions for installation and use. the child restraint is compatible with your
tipping over during normal vehicle brak- In addition, there are many types of child child. Always follow all of the recommended
ing or cornering. restraint systems available for larger children procedures.
. After attaching a child restraint, test it that should be used for maximum protection. . Check the child restraint in your vehicle to
before you place the child in it. Push it be sure it is compatible with vehicle’s seat
from side to side and tug it forward to CAUTION: belt system.
make sure that it is held securely in place. . Refer to the tables later in this section for a
The child restraint system should not Remember that a child restraint system left
in a closed vehicle can become very hot. list of the recommended fitment positions.
move more than 25 mm (1 in). If the
restraint is not secure, tighten the belt Check the seating surface and buckles before
placing your child in a child restraint system.
Mass groupGUID-38A5CFB0-B9BA-49B0-BE4E-73870B9CE2F7
of child seat
as necessary, or install the restraint in
another seat and test it again. Mass group Child’s weight
. Check the child restraint system in your Group 0 up to 10 kg
vehicle to be sure that it is compatible Group 0+ up to 13 kg
with the vehicle’s seat belt system.
Group I 9 to 18 kg
. If a child restraint system is not anchored
properly, the risk of a child being injured Group II 15 to 25 kg
in a collision or a sudden stop greatly Group III 22 to 36 kg
increases.
. Improper use or improper installation of
a child restraint can increase the risk or
severity of injury for both the child and
other occupants of the vehicle and can
lead to serious injury or death in an
JVR0372X
Child safety seat categories 0+ and I
JVR0373X
Child safety seat categories II and III
Approved child restraint positions (with ISOFIX) ISOFIX CHILD RESTRAINT SYSTEM (if
GUID-9C7934F6-3543-4F51-9F9E-26F057011FB7
The following restriction is applied when using child restraints varying by infants weight and
equipped) GUID-7DC76B09-0EA2-4072-B4F4-426A6B9E5468
installation position.
Suitability
Mass group
Front passenger seat 2nd row outer seat 2nd row center seat
F ISO/L1 X X X
Carry-cot
G ISO/L2 X X X
0 (< 10 kg) E ISO/R1 X IL*1 X
E ISO/R1 X IL*1 X
0+ (< 13 X
D ISO/R2 X IL*1
kg)
C ISO/R3 X IL*1 X JVR0351X
SSS0637
ISOFIX lower anchor location
The ISOFIX anchors are located as shown. A
label is attached to the seatback to help you CHILD RESTRAINT ANCHORAGE (if attach and tighten the top tether strap to the
locate the ISOFIX anchors. equipped) top tether anchor (loop). Refer to the child
D23A131129-447E8B16-98E2-4348-8705-99CD5A3FBB6A restraint instructions and the following steps.
ISOFIX child restraint anchor attach- Your vehicle is designed to accommodate a
ments child restraint system on the rear seat. When
GUID-1DCB5C34-B3C7-4A41-8A79-DA750298FBD7 installing a child restraint system, carefully read
and follow the instructions in this manual and
those supplied with the child restraint system.
WARNING:
Child restraint anchorages are designed to
withstand only those loads imposed by
correctly fitted child restraints. Under no
circumstances are they to be used for adult
seat belts, harnesses or for attaching other JVR0422X
items or equipment to the vehicle. Doing so On the rear right outboard seating position
SSS0644 could damage the child restraint anchorages. 1. On the rear right outboard seating posi-
Anchor attachment
The child restraint will not be properly tion:
ISOFIX child restraints include two rigid attach- installed using the damaged anchorage,
and a child could be seriously injured or 1. Remove the head restraint of the rear
ments that can be connected to two anchors right outboard seat.
located in the seat. With this system, you do not killed in a collision.
2. Route the top tether strap through
have to use a vehicle seat belt to secure the
Anchorage location the right top tether anchor (loop)
child restraint. Check your child restraint for a D23A131129-5D3B4815-F77A-48B1-B607-0B34045C4EA2
label stating that it is compatible with the and under the center shoulder belt .
ISOFIX child restraints. This information may 3. Attach the top tether strap to the
also be in the instructions provided by the child top tether anchor (loop) at the rear
restraint manufacturer. center seating position.
ISOFIX child restraints generally require the use 2. On the rear left outboard seating posi-
of a top tether strap or other anti-rotation tion:
devices such as support legs. When installing 1. Remove the head restraint of the rear
ISOFIX child restraints, carefully read and follow left outboard seat.
the instructions in this manual and those 2. Route the top tether strap through
supplied with the child restraints. See “Child the left top tether anchor (loop) .
restraint installation using ISOFIX” (P.1-18).
3. Attach the top tether strap to the
JVR0418X top tether anchor (loop) at the rear
The anchor points (loops) are located on the center seating position.
top of the rear seatback. 3. On the rear center seating position:
If the child restraint manufacturer recom- 1. Remove the head restraint of the rear
mends that the top tether strap be attached, left (or right) outboard seat.
2. Route the top tether strap through . Child restraint anchorages are designed straints” (P.1-6).) Store the removed head
the center top tether anchor (loop) . to withstand only those loads imposed restraint in a secure place. Be sure to install
3. Attach the top tether strap to the by correctly fitted child restraints. Under the head restraint when the child restraint
left top tether anchor (loop) (or right no circumstances are they to be used for is removed. If the seating position does not
top tether anchor (loop) through adult seat belts, harnesses or for attach- have an adjustable head restraint and it is
under the center shoulder belt ). ing other items or equipment to the interfering with the proper child restraint
vehicle. Doing so could damage the child fit, try another seating position or a differ-
Tighten the top tether according to the child
restraint anchorages. The child restraint ent child restraint.
restraint manufacturer’s instructions.
will not be properly installed using the
When the top tether strap is properly tightened, damaged anchorage, and a child could be
the top tether anchor (loop) may bend. This is seriously injured or killed in a collision.
normal and will not damage the vehicle.
Installation on rear outboard seats
CHILD RESTRAINT INSTALLATION USING GUID-416D7C15-0486-47F4-B0B4-B7AE71CB1EA4
WARNING:
. Attach ISOFIX child restraints only at the
specified locations. For the ISOFIX lower
anchor locations, see “ISOFIX child re- SSS0754A
straint system” (P.1-16). If a child restraint Front-facing: Step 4
is not secured properly, your child could 4. Shorten the rigid attachment to have the
be seriously injured or killed in an acci- child restraint firmly tightened; press down-
dent. ward and rearward firmly in the center
. Do not install child restraints that require of the child restraint with your knee to
the use of a top tether strap to seating compress the vehicle seat cushion and
SSS0646A
positions that do not have a top tether seatback.
Front-facing: Steps 1 and 2
anchor. 5. If the child restraint is equipped with a top
Be sure to follow the manufacturer’s instruc-
. Do not secure a child restraint in the tions for the proper use of your child restraint. tether strap, route the top tether strap and
center rear seating position using the Follow these steps to install a front-facing child secure the tether strap to the tether
ISOFIX lower anchors. The child restraint restraint on the rear outboard seats using anchor point. (See “Child restraint ancho-
will not be secured properly. ISOFIX: rage” (P.1-17).)
. Inspect the lower anchors by inserting 1. Position the child restraint on the seat . 6. If the child restraint is equipped with other
your fingers into the lower anchor area anti-rotation devices such as support legs,
2. Secure the child restraint anchor attach- use them instead of the top tether strap
and feeling to make sure there are no
ments to the ISOFIX lower anchors . following the child restraint manufacturer’s
obstructions over the ISOFIX anchors,
such as seat belt webbing or seat cushion 3. The back of the child restraint should be instructions.
material. The child restraint will not be secured against the vehicle seatback. Re-
secured properly if the ISOFIX anchors move the head restraint to obtain the
are obstructed. correct child restraint fit. (See “Head re-
ISOFIX:
1. Position the child restraint on the seat .
2. Secure the child restraint anchor attach-
ments to the ISOFIX lower anchors .
SSS0755A SSS0757A
Front-facing: Step 7 Rear-facing: Step 6
7. Test the child restraint before you place the 6. Test the child restraint before you place the
child in it . Push the child restraint from child in it . Push the child restraint from
side to side and tug it forward to make sure side to side and tug it forward to make sure
that it is held securely in place. SSS0756A that it is held securely in place.
8. Check to make sure that the child restraint Rear-facing: Step 3 7. Check to make sure that the child restraint
is properly secured prior to each use. If the 3. Shorten the rigid attachment to have the is properly secured prior to each use. If the
child restraint is loose, repeat steps 3 child restraint firmly tightened; press down- child restraint is loose, repeat steps 3
through 7. ward and rearward firmly in the center through 6.
of the child restraint with your hand to
Rear-facing:
D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8 compress the vehicle seat cushion and CHILD RESTRAINT INSTALLATION USING
seatback. THREE-POINT TYPE SEAT BELT
D23A131129-7523374E-6645-44D0-BCEC-CF9EFA4833FE
4. If the child restraint is equipped with a top
tether strap, route the top tether strap and Installation on rear seats (Double Cab
secure the tether strap to the tether models) D23A131129-C9A11D9C-A3FE-4C1C-83A8-A91A861E6493
anchor point. (See “Child restraint ancho- Front-facing:
rage” (P.1-17).) D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
Be sure to follow the manufacturer’s instruc-
5. If the child restraint is equipped with other tions for the proper use of your child restraint.
anti-rotation devices such as support legs, Follow these steps to install a front-facing child
use them instead of the top tether strap restraint on the rear seats using three-point
following the child restraint manufacturer’s type seat belt without automatic locking mode:
instructions.
SSS0649A
Rear-facing: Steps 1 and 2
Be sure to follow the manufacturer’s instruc-
tions for the proper use of your child restraint.
Follow these steps to install a rear-facing child
restraint on the rear outboard seats using
Rear-facing:D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
Be sure to follow the manufacturer’s instruc-
tions for the proper use of your child restraint.
Follow these steps to install a rear-facing child
restraint on the rear seats using three-point
type seat belt without automatic locking mode:
SSS0758A SSS0647A
Front-facing: Step 1 Front-facing: Step 4
1. Position the child restraint on the seat . 4. Remove any additional slack from the seat
belt; press downward and rearward
firmly in the center of the child restraint
with your knee to compress the vehicle
seat cushion and seatback while pulling up
on the seat belt. SSS0759A
Rear-facing: Step 1
1. Position the child restraint on the seat .
SSS0493A
Front-facing: Step 2
2. Route the seat belt tongue through the
child restraint and insert it into the buckle
until you hear and feel the latch engage.
SSS0638A
3. To prevent slack in the seat belt webbing, it
is necessary to secure the seat belt in place Front-facing: Step 5
5. Test the child restraint before you place the SSS0654A
with locking devices attached to the child
restraint. child in it . Push the child restraint from Rear-facing: Step 2
side to side and tug it forward to make sure 2. Route the seat belt tongue through the
that it is held securely in place. child restraint and insert it into the buckle
6. Check to make sure that the child restraint until you hear and feel the latch engage.
is properly secured prior to each use. If the 3. To prevent slack in the seat belt webbing, it
child restraint is loose, repeat steps 3 is necessary to secure the seat belt in place
through 5. with locking devices attached to the child
SSS0639A
Rear-facing: Step 4
4. Remove any additional slack from the seat
belt; press downward and rearward
firmly in the center of the child restraint
with your hand to compress the vehicle
seat cushion and seatback while pulling up
on the seat belt.
SSS0658A
Rear-facing: Step 5
5. Test the child restraint before you place the
child in it . Push the child restraint from
side to side and tug it forward to make sure
that it is held securely in place.
6. Check to make sure that the child restraint
is properly secured prior to each use. If the
SSS0360C
Front-facing: Step 4
SSS0300A 4. Route the seat belt tongue through the
child restraint and insert it into the buckle
Front-facing:
D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8 until you hear and feel the latch engage.
WARNING: Be sure to follow the manufacturer’s instruc- 5. To prevent slack in the seat belt webbing, it
. Never install a rear facing child restraint tions for the proper use of your child restraint. is necessary to secure the seat belt in place
system on the front seat. Supplemental Follow these steps to install a front-facing child with locking devices attached to the child
front-impact air bags inflate with great restraint on the front passenger’s seat using restraint.
force. A rear-facing child restraint system three-point type seat belt without automatic
could be struck by the supplemental locking mode:
front-impact air bags in an accident and 1. Move the seat to the rearmost position .
could seriously injure or kill your child.
. NISSAN recommends that a child re-
straint be installed on the rear seat
(Double Cab models). However, subject
to local regulations, if you must install a
front facing child restraint system on the
front passenger’s seat, move the passen-
ger’s seat to the rearmost position.
. Child restraints for infants must be used SSS0647B
in the rear-facing direction and therefore Front-facing: Step 6
must not be used on the front seat. 6. Remove any additional slack from the seat
. Failure to use the seat belts will result in SSS0627 belt; press downward and rearward
the child restraint system not being Front-facing: Steps 1 and 2 firmly in the center of the child restraint
properly secured. It could tip over or 2. Adjust or remove the head restraint . with your knee to compress the vehicle
otherwise be unsecured and cause injury seat cushion and seatback while pulling up
3. Position the child restraint in the seat.
to the child in a sudden stop or collision. on the seat belt.
CHILD RESTRAINT INSTALLATION USING 2. Route the seat belt tongue through the
TWO-POINT TYPE SEAT BELT (if child restraint and insert it into the buckle
until you hear and feel the latch engage.
equipped) GUID-AAB72E35-5E79-4AEF-BBD3-729415B4A871
Installation on rear center seat
GUID-981B58ED-D1A4-44A6-8DC6-9F1FD15C6256
SSS0302G
Front-facing: Step 7
7. Test the child restraint before you place the
child in it . Push the child restraint from
SSS0783A
side to side and tug it forward to make sure
that it is held securely in place. Front-facing: Step 3
SSS0760A 3. Remove any additional slack from the seat
8. Check to make sure that the child restraint belt; press downward and rearward
is properly secured prior to each use. If the Front-facing: Step 1
firmly in the center of the child restraint
child restraint is loose, repeat steps 5 Front-facing:
D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8 with your knee to compress the vehicle
through 7. Be sure to follow the manufacturer’s instruc- seat cushion and seatback while pulling up
tions for the proper use of your child restraint. on the seat belt.
Follow these steps to install a front-facing child
restraint on the rear center seat using two-
point type seat belt:
1. Position the child restraint on the seat .
SSS0784A
Front-facing: Step 4
4. Test the child restraint before you place the
child in it . Push the child restraint from
SSS0782A side to side and tug it forward to make sure
that it is held securely in place.
Front-facing: Step 2
5. Check to make sure that the child restraint 2. Route the seat belt tongue through the 5. Check to make sure that the child restraint
is properly secured prior to each use. If the child restraint and insert it into the buckle is properly secured prior to each use. If the
child restraint is loose, repeat steps 3 until you hear and feel the latch engage. child restraint is loose, repeat steps 3
through 4. through 4.
Rear-facing:
D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
SSS0785A
Rear-facing: Step 3
SSS0761A
3. Remove any additional slack from the seat
belt; press downward and rearward
Rear-facing: Step 1
firmly in the center of the child restraint
Be sure to follow the manufacturer’s instruc-
with your hand to compress the vehicle
tions for the proper use of your child restraint.
seat cushion and seatback while pulling up
Follow these steps to install a rear-facing child
on the seat belt.
restraint on the rear center seat using 2-point
type seat belt:
1. Position the child restraint on the seat .
SSS0763A
Rear-facing: Step 4
4. Test the child restraint before you place the
SSS0762A child in it . Push the child restraint from
Rear-facing: Step 2 side to side and tug it forward to make sure
that it is held securely in place.
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT
SYSTEM (SRS) (if equipped)
D23A131129-7E26D5FA-E059-4E66-8A46-AC447D1179B5
SSS0131A
SSS0006
SSS0132A
SSS0007
ing forward, sitting sideways, or out of
WARNING: position in any way, you and your pas-
. The supplemental front air bags ordina- sengers are at greater risk of injury or
rily will not inflate in the event of a side death in an accident. You and your
impact, rear impact, rollover, or lower passengers may also receive serious or
severity frontal collision. Always wear fatal injuries from the supplemental
your seat belts to help reduce the risk or front-impact air bag if you are up against
severity of injury in various kinds of it when it inflates. Always sit back against
accidents. the seatback and as far away as practical
from the steering wheel or instrument
. The seat belts and the supplemental panel. Always use the seat belts.
front-impact air bags are most effective
when you are sitting well back and up- . Keep hands on the outside of the steering
right in the seat. The front-impact air wheel. Placing them inside the steering SSS0008
bags inflate with great force. If you and wheel rim could increase the risk of injury
your passengers are unrestrained, lean-
1-26 Safety — seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system
WARNING:
. Never let children ride unrestrained or
extend their hands or face out of the
window. Do not attempt to hold them in
your lap or arms. Some examples of
dangerous riding positions are shown in
the illustrations.
. Children may be severely injured or killed
when the air bags inflate if they are not
properly restrained.
SSS0009 SSS0140
. Never install a rear-facing child restraint
system in the front seat. An inflating
supplemental front-impact air bag could
seriously injure or kill your child. (See
“Child restraints” (P.1-13).)
SSS0099 SSS0159
SSS0059A
SSS0100 SSS0162
JVR0243X SPA1097
Air bag warning label
The label warns: The supplemental air bag warning light, dis-
playing in the instrument panel, monitors the
“NEVER use a rearward facing child restraint on circuits for the air bag systems, pre-tensioner
a seat protected by an ACTIVE AIRBAG in front seat belt system (if equipped) and all related
of it, DEATH or SERIOUS INJURY to the CHILD wiring.
can occur.”
When the ignition switch is in the “ON” position,
In vehicles equipped with a front-impact pas- the SRS air bag warning light illuminates for
senger air bag system, use a rear-facing child about 7 seconds and then turns off. This
restraint system only on the rear seats (Double indicates that the SRS air bag systems are
Cab models). operational.
When installing a child restraint system in your If any of the following conditions occur, the air
vehicle, always follow the child restraint system bag and/or pre-tensioner seat belt system
manufacturer’s instructions for installation. For need servicing:
additional information, see “Child restraints”
(P.1-13). . The SRS air bag warning light remains on
after approximately 7 seconds.
. The SRS air bag warning light flashes
intermittently.
. The SRS air bag warning light does not
illuminate at all.
Under these conditions, the air bag and/or pre-
tensioner seat belt system may not operate
properly. They must be checked and repaired.
Contact a NISSAN dealer immediately.
modified or disconnected. Unauthorized a higher severity impact. It may not inflate in Supplemental curtain side-impact air
electrical test equipment and probing certain collisions. bag system (if equipped)
devices should not be used on the sup- Vehicle damage (or lack of it) is not always an
D23A131129-AF9C33A5-50BD-4693-9B38-A98DBB4F4DB7
plemental air bag systems. The supplemental curtain side-impact air bag is
indication of proper supplemental driver’s knee located at the roof rails.
. The SRS wiring harness connectors are air bag system operation.
yellow for easy identification. The supplemental curtain side-impact air bag
Supplemental side-impact air bag sys- system is designed to inflate in higher severity
When the air bags inflate, a fairly loud noise tem (if equipped) side collisions, although it may inflate if the
may be heard, followed by the release of D23A131129-6D270FAE-2DEB-44BB-8BCE-8FAE26687FFC forces in another type of collision are similar to
smoke. This smoke is not harmful and does those of a higher severity side impact. It may
not indicate a fire. Care should be taken not to not inflate in certain side collisions. Vehicle
inhale it, as it may cause irritation and choking. damage (or lack of it) is not always an indica-
Those with a history of a breathing condition tion of proper supplemental curtain side-im-
should get fresh air promptly. pact air bag system operation.
Supplemental front-impact air bag SRS AIR BAG DEPLOYMENT CONDI-
system D23A131129-E4940228-6BE9-4459-93FF-C3A09DCD9CAF TIONS D23A131129-55E3B910-F2B6-4285-A380-6EFF851E49FF
The driver’s supplemental front-impact air bag The SRS air bags activate in the event of a front
is located at the center of the steering wheel. or side impact in which the vehicle occupants
The passenger’s supplemental front-impact air may be severely injured even if they are
bag is located at the instrument panel above SSS1092 wearing the seat belts properly.
the glove box. They may not activate when the crash energy
The supplemental side-impact air bag is lo-
The supplemental front-impact air bag system cated at the outside of the front seats’ seat- is absorbed and/or distributed by the vehicle
is designed to inflate in higher severity frontal backs. body. Vehicle damage (or lack of it) is not
collisions, although it may inflate if the forces in always an indication of proper SRS air bag
another type of collision are similar to those of The supplemental side-impact air bag system
system operation.
a higher severity frontal impact. It may not is designed to inflate in higher severity side
inflate in certain frontal collisions. Vehicle collisions, although it may inflate if the forces in When the SRS air bag will deploy
another type of collision are similar to those of D23A131129-2435CBC7-E5F1-49AD-9B73-72DB79FDD393
damage (or lack of it) is not always an indica-
a higher severity side impact. It may not inflate Supplemental front-impact air bags and
tion of proper supplemental front-impact air
bag system operation. in certain side collisions. Vehicle damage (or driver’s knee air bag (if equipped):
D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
lack of it) is not always an indication of proper The supplemental front-impact air bag and
Supplemental driver’s knee air bag supplemental side-impact air bag system op- driver’s knee air bag (if equipped) systems are
system (if equipped) eration. designed to inflate in higher severity frontal
GUID-716F5D80-B6FC-458A-A435-75EA6C34A30F
collisions. Some examples are shown in the
The supplemental driver’s knee air bag is
following illustrations.
located under the steering column.
The supplemental driver’s knee air bag system
is designed to inflate in higher severity frontal
collisions, although it may inflate if the forces in
another type of collision are similar to those of
JVR0423X JVR0161X
(supplemental side-impact air bag system)
The supplemental front-impact air bag and
driver’s knee air bag (if equipped) systems will
deploy in the event of an impact which exceeds
a 25 km/h (16 MPH) frontal collision with a solid
wall that does not move or deform.
The supplemental front-impact air bag and
driver’s knee air bag (if equipped) systems may
also deploy when the vehicle receives severe
damage to the undercarriage.
JVR0162X
JVR0424X (supplemental curtain side-impact air bag system)
. The supplemental side-impact and curtain
. Hitting a curb, pavement edge or hard side-impact air bags will deploy in the event
surface at high speed of a side impact with a normal passenger
. Falling into a deep hole or ditch vehicle that exceeds at a speed of 25 km/h
. Landing hard on the ground after jumping (16 MPH).
Supplemental side-impact and curtain side- When the SRS air bag is unlikely to
impact air bags (if equipped):
D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8 deploy D23A131129-D9E3985E-CC2E-439B-91C9-EBECFF8D69A6
The supplemental side-impact and curtain The SRS air bags may not deploy in cases
side-impact air bag systems are designed to where the impact is not forceful enough to
inflate in higher severity side collisions. Some inflate the SRS air bags.
examples are shown in the following illustra-
tions. For example, if the vehicle strikes an object,
such as a parked vehicle or sign pole, which can
move or deform on impact, the SRS air bags are
JVR0163X
JVR0157X
JVR0159X
. Vehicle rollover . Work around or on the pre-tensioner seat . If you need to dispose of the SRS or scrap
belt system should be done by a NISSAN the vehicle, contact a NISSAN dealer.
Supplemental side-impact and curtain side- dealer. The SRS wiring should not be Correct disposal procedures are set forth
impact air bags (if equipped):
D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8 modified or disconnected. Unauthorized in the appropriate NISSAN Service Man-
electrical test equipment and probing ual. Incorrect disposal procedures could
devices should not be used on the pre- cause personal injury.
tensioner seat belt system.
The supplemental front-impact air bags and
. If you need to dispose of the pre-ten- pre-tensioner seat belts (if equipped) are de-
sioner seat belt system, or scrap the signed to activate on a one-time-only basis. As
vehicle, contact a NISSAN dealer. Correct a reminder, unless the SRS air bag warning light
pre-tensioner disposal procedures are is damaged, the SRS air bag warning light
set forth in the appropriate NISSAN Ser- remains illuminated after inflation has oc-
vice Manual. Incorrect disposal proce- curred. The repair and replacement of the SRS
dures could cause personal injury. should be done only by a NISSAN dealer.
The pre-tensioner is encased with the front When maintenance work is required on the
JVR0160X
seat belt’s retractor and anchor. These seat vehicle, information about the air bags, pre-
. A frontal collision with a parked or moving belts are used the same as conventional seat tensioner seat belts and related parts should
vehicle belts. be pointed out to the person performing the
. A rear collision When the pre-tensioner seat belt activates, a maintenance. The ignition switch should al-
fairly loud noise may be heard, followed by the ways be in the “LOCK” position when working
PRE-TENSIONER SEAT BELT SYSTEM (if release of smoke. This smoke is not harmful under the hood or inside the vehicle.
equipped)
D23A131129-D2269986-BC03-4575-BCD9-1A9AB182A9A2
and does not indicate a fire. Care should be
taken not to inhale it, as it may cause irritation
WARNING: and choking. Those with a history of a breath-
ing condition should get fresh air promptly.
. The pre-tensioner seat belt cannot be
reused after activation. It must be re- REPAIR AND REPLACEMENT PROCE-
placed together with the retractor and DURE D23A131129-1A9EADA6-086C-48A7-8C1C-710F47D1EBD6
buckle as a unit.
. If the vehicle becomes involved in a WARNING:
collision but the pre-tensioner is not
activated, be sure to have the pre-ten- . Once the supplemental front-impact air
sioner system checked and, if necessary, bags have been inflated, the air bag
replaced by a NISSAN dealer. modules will not function and must be
replaced. The air bag modules must be
. No unauthorized changes should be replaced by a NISSAN dealer. The inflated
made to any components or wiring of air bag modules cannot be repaired.
the pre-tensioner seat belt system. This
is to prevent accidental activation of the . The air bag systems should be inspected
pre-tensioner seat belt or damage to the by a NISSAN dealer if there is any damage
pre-tensioner seat belt system. to the vehicle.
Cockpit ..................................................................................................................
.... 2-3 Oil control system (if equipped for diesel
Left-Hand Drive (LHD) model .......................................................
.... 2-3 engine model) ....................................................................................
.... 2-31 >
Right-Hand Drive (RHD) model ...................................................
.... 2-4 Headlight and turn signal switch ................................................
.... 2-33
Instrument panel ..........................................................................................
.... 2-5 Headlight switch ..............................................................................
.... 2-33
Left-Hand Drive (LHD) model .......................................................
.... 2-5 Headlight aiming control (if equipped) .......................... .... 2-34
Right-Hand Drive (RHD) model ...................................................
.... 2-6 Battery saver system ...................................................................
.... 2-35
Meters and gauges .....................................................................................
.... 2-7 Turn signal switch ..........................................................................
.... 2-35
Speedometer and odometer .......................................................
.... 2-8 Fog light switch (if equipped) .........................................................
.... 2-36
Tachometer ...............................................................................................
.... 2-8 Front fog lights (if equipped) .................................................
.... 2-36
Engine coolant temperature gauge ...................................... .... 2-9 Rear fog light (if equipped) ......................................................
.... 2-37
Fuel gauge ..................................................................................................
.... 2-9 Cargo light switch (if equipped) ....................................................
.... 2-37
Instrument brightness control ................................................
.... 2-10 Wiper and washer switch ...................................................................
.... 2-37
Compass (if equipped) ...........................................................................
.... 2-11 Windshield wiper and washer switch ............................. .... 2-37
Zone variation change procedure ........................................ .... 2-11 Defogger switch (if equipped) ........................................................
.... 2-38
Warning lights, indicator lights and Horn .....................................................................................................................
.... 2-39
audible reminders .....................................................................................
.... 2-13 Windows ...........................................................................................................
.... 2-39
Checking lights ....................................................................................
.... 2-14 Manual windows (if equipped) .................................................. 2-39
Warning lights .......................................................................................
.... 2-14 Power windows (if equipped) ................................................
.... 2-39
Indicator lights .....................................................................................
.... 2-17 Auto slide back window system (if equipped) ......... .... 2-41
Audible reminders .............................................................................
.... 2-19 Sunroof (if equipped) .............................................................................
.... 2-41
Vehicle information display (models with Automatic sunroof .........................................................................
.... 2-41
color display) .................................................................................................
.... 2-20 Power outlets ...............................................................................................
.... 2-42
Indicators for operation ................................................................
.... 2-21 Storage ..............................................................................................................
.... 2-44
Maintenance indicators ................................................................
.... 2-24 Glove box ...............................................................................................
.... 2-44
Trip computer .......................................................................................
.... 2-25 Console box (if equipped) .........................................................
.... 2-44
Oil control system (if equipped for diesel Sunglasses holder (if equipped) .......................................... .... 2-44
engine model) .......................................................................................
.... 2-29 Cup holders ..........................................................................................
.... 2-44
Clock and outside air temperature (if equipped) ..... .... 2-30 Roof rack (if equipped) ................................................................
.... 2-45
Vehicle information display (models without Card holder (if equipped) ..........................................................
.... 2-46
color display) .................................................................................................
.... 2-30
Sun visors ........................................................................................................
.... 2-46
Outside air temperature (if equipped) .............................. .... 2-31
Interior lights ................................................................................................
.... 2-47
Trip computer .......................................................................................
.... 2-31
Interior light switch (if equipped) ....................................... .... 2-47
COCKPIT
D23A131129-EB56C13A-C6EE-4C84-8505-4D4397DB8CB5
— Audio control steering switch*
LEFT-HAND DRIVE (LHD) MODEL — Vehicle information display control
D23A131129-461D724C-E8D4-431A-A211-9398D746ADCD
switch*
8. Wiper and washer switch
9. Steering-wheel-mounted controls* (right
side)
— Cruise control system*
— Hands-Free Phone System switch*
— Voice recognition system switch*
10. Shift lever
— Automatic Transmission (AT)
— Manual Transmission (MT)
11. Vehicle Dynamic Control (VDC) OFF
switch*
12. Fuel-filler lid opener switch*
13. Tilting steering wheel lever*
*: if equipped
JVC0781X
RIGHT-HAND DRIVE (RHD) MODEL 6. Headlight, fog light and turn signal switch
D23A131129-2BA9F5D7-8161-4D7A-9F5D-F31107169F9F — Headlight
— Turn signal
— Fog light*
7. TRIP/RESET switch for twin trip od-
ometer/Trip computer mode switch
(models without color display)
8. TRIP/RESET switch for twin trip odometer
(models with color display)
9. Instrument brightness control switch
(models with color display)
10. Cup holder*
11. Cup holder (for front bench seat models)
12. Tilting steering wheel lever*
13. Auto slide back window switch*
14. Fuel-filler lid opener switch*
15. Vehicle Dynamic Control (VDC) OFF
switch*
16. Headlight aiming control switch*
*: if equipped
JVC0782X
INSTRUMENT PANEL
D23A131129-A32C3578-39F4-4F2E-A8D4-97767F14EA26
— Power steering
LEFT-HAND DRIVE (LHD) MODEL 10. Ignition switch (models without Intelligent
D23A131129-BF7DBE9A-3AB8-4A46-A5E5-E602A487762A
Key system)
11. Parking brake
— Operation
— Check
12. Hill descent control switch*
13. Cargo light switch*
14. Differential lock mode switch*
15. USB (Universal Serial Bus) connection
port/iPod connection port
— Auxiliary (AUX) input jack
16. Four-Wheel Drive (4WD) mode switch*
17. Heater and air conditioner control
18. Glove box
— Fuse box
19. Side ventilator
: 4WD models
: 2WD models
*: if equipped
JVC0919X
JVC0689X
JVI1233X
JVI0278X
Odometer/twin trip odometer:
D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
The tachometer indicates the engine speed in
The odometer/twin trip odometer is displayed
revolutions per minute (rpm). Do not rev the
when the ignition switch is in the “ON” position.
engine into the red zone .
JVI1041X The odometer displays the total distance the
The red zone varies with models.
vehicle has been driven.
Odometer/Twin trip odometer:
D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8 The twin trip odometer displays the distance
The odometer/twin trip odometer is displayed of individual trips.
in the vehicle information display when the
ignition switch is in the “ON” position.
The odometer displays the total distance the
vehicle has been driven.
The twin trip odometer displays the distance
ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE The engine coolant temperature gauge The fuel gauge indicates the approximate fuel
GAUGE D23A131129-AC507E4D-748F-49CB-9422-D729C2C86322 indicates the engine coolant temperature. level in the tank when the ignition switch is in
The engine coolant temperature is normal the “ON” position.
Models withGUID-3B43B9A7-DD7B-480D-A883-04AB63AF1C39
color display when the gauge is within the zone shown The gauge may move slightly during braking,
in the illustration. turning, accelerating, or going up and down
The engine coolant temperature will vary with hills due to movement of fuel in the tank.
the outside air temperature and driving condi- The low fuel warning appears on the vehicle
tions. information display when the fuel level in the
tank is getting low. Refuel as soon as it is
CAUTION: convenient, preferably before the gauge reads
the empty (0) position.
. If the gauge indicates the engine coolant
The arrow, , indicates that the fuel-filler lid
temperature is near the hot (H) end of the
is located on the left side of the vehicle.
normal range, reduce vehicle speed to
decrease the temperature.
CAUTION:
JVI0820X . If the gauge is over the normal range,
stop the vehicle as soon as safely possi- Refuel before the gauge reads the empty (0)
The engine coolant temperature gauge indi- ble and let the engine idle. position.
cates the engine coolant temperature. . If the engine is overheated, continued
The engine coolant temperature is normal There is a small reserve of fuel in the tank when
operation of the vehicle may seriously the fuel gauge reads the empty (0) position.
when the gauge needle points within the zone damage the engine. (See “If your vehicle
shown in the illustration. overheats” (P.6-11) for immediate action Models without color display
GUID-D2AC8831-DA41-418E-9487-CFCBAE256991
The engine coolant temperature will vary with required.)
the outside air temperature and driving condi-
tions. FUEL GAUGE
D23A131129-DE289BE5-492C-468F-9950-9FF1FBBC01FE
JVI1235X
CAUTION:
Refuel before the gauge reads 0 (empty). JVI0661M
There is a small reserve of fuel in the tank when The instrument brightness control switch can JVI1236X
the fuel gauge reads 0 (empty). be operated when the ignition switch is in the
“ON” position. When the switch is operated, the The instrument brightness control operates
INSTRUMENT BRIGHTNESS CONTROL vehicle information display switches to the when the ignition switch is in the “ON” position
D23A131129-DCB79E8B-13E0-4540-BE37-A0BB2FD164FB
brightness adjustment mode. and the headlight switch is in either the or
Models withGUID-43BE560D-2DD0-497A-9493-416D04B5D04B
color display position.
Push the + side of the switch to brighten the
meter panel lights. The bar moves to the + Turn the instrument brightness control switch
side. to adjust the brightness of the meter. The
brightness indicator will be shown briefly in
Push the - side of the switch to dim the lights. the vehicle information display when the con-
The bar moves to the − side. trol is turned.
The vehicle information display returns to the When the brightness level reaches the max-
normal display when the instrument brightness imum or minimum, a beep will sound.
control switch is not operated for more than 5
seconds.
JVI1042X
SIC3014
NOS1741
dealer.
. The compass may not indicate the correct
compass point in tunnels or while driving
up or down a steep hill. (The compass
returns to the correct compass point when
the vehicle moves to an area where the
geomagnetism is stabilized.)
CAUTION:
. Do not install a ski rack, antenna, etc.
which are attached to the vehicle by
means of a magnet. They affect the
operation of the compass.
. When cleaning the mirror, use a paper
towel or similar material dampened with
glass cleaner. Do not spray glass cleaner
directly on the mirror as it may cause the
liquid cleaner to enter the mirror housing.
Engine oil pressure warning light Front fog lights indicator light* *: if equipped
. Even if you judge it to be safe, have your Anti-lock Braking System (ABS) warning in-
vehicle towed because driving it could be dicator (if equipped): Diesel Particulate Filter (DPF)
D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
dangerous.
When the parking brake is released and the warning light (if equipped)
GUID-F071115C-DCD3-4944-B886-D3F3D1975296
. Depressing the brake pedal without the brake fluid level is sufficient, if both the brake When the DPF warning light illuminates, it
engine running and/or with a low brake warning light and the Anti-lock Braking System indicates that particulate matter is accumu-
fluid level could increase the stopping (ABS) warning light illuminate, it may indicate lated to the specified amount of the limit in the
distance and require greater pedal travel the ABS is not functioning properly. Have the filter and the filter needs to regenerate. For
distance and effort. brake system checked, and if necessary re- filter regeneration details, see “Diesel Particu-
paired, by a NISSAN dealer promptly. (See “Anti- late Filter (DPF)” (P.5-5).
The brake warning light indicates the parking
lock Braking System (ABS) warning light” (P.2-
brake system operation, a low brake fluid level
14).)
of the brake system and an Anti-lock Braking CAUTION:
System (ABS) malfunction.
Charge warning light If you continue driving with the DPF warning
Parking brake warning indicator:
D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8 GUID-6393B705-EF96-423F-A19C-E5F7A491FEEF light on without performing the filter regen-
When the ignition switch is placed in the “ON” When the ignition switch is in the “ON” position, eration, this will lead to particulate matter
position, the brake warning light illuminates. the charge warning light illuminates. After overload in the filter.
When the engine is started and the parking starting the engine, the charge warning light If this occurs, then the Malfunction Indicator
brake is released, the brake warning light turns turns off. This indicates that the charging Light (MIL) will turn on. The performance of
off. system is operational. the engine might be limited to protect the
If the parking brake is not fully released, the If the charge warning light illuminates while the DPF system. See a NISSAN dealer to perform
brake warning light remains on. Be sure that engine is running, or while driving, it may the service regeneration.
the brake warning light has turned off before indicate that the charging system is not
driving. (See “Parking brake” (P.3-25).) functioning properly and may need servicing.
When the charge warning light illuminates Door open warning light
Low brake fluid warning indicator: GUID-5F7F4230-2F74-4C29-9F67-424811C2787C
D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8 while driving, stop the vehicle safely as soon When the ignition switch is in the “ON” position,
If the brake warning light illuminates while the as possible. Stop the engine and check the
engine is running, or while driving, and the the door open warning light illuminates if any
alternator belt. If the alternator belt is loose, of the doors are open or not closed securely.
parking brake is released, it may indicate the broken or missing, the charging system needs
brake fluid level is low. repair. (See “Drive belt” (P.8-14).)
When the brake warning light illuminates while If the alternator belt appears to be functioning Engine oil pressure warning light
GUID-5E4356F4-6956-4764-AD9C-2DC72FDA1CF4
driving, stop the vehicle safely as soon as correctly but the charge warning light remains When the ignition switch is in the “ON” position,
possible. Stop the engine and check the brake illuminated, have the charging system checked the engine oil pressure warning light illumi-
fluid level. If the brake fluid level is at the by a NISSAN dealer promptly. nates. After starting the engine, the engine oil
minimum mark, add brake fluid as necessary.
pressure warning light turns off. This indicates
(See “Brake fluid” (P.8-16).)
CAUTION: that the oil pressure sensors in the engine are
If the brake fluid level is sufficient, have the operational.
brake system checked by a NISSAN dealer Do not continue driving if the alternator belt
is loose, broken or missing. If the engine oil pressure warning light illumi-
promptly.
nates or blinks while the engine is running, it
may indicate that the engine oil pressure is low.
Stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible. — in the 4LO position, stop the vehicle
Stop the engine immediately and call a NISSAN and shift the transmission lever to CAUTION:
dealer. the “N” (Neutral) position with the Continuing vehicle operation without proper
brake pedal depressed and shift the servicing of the engine control system could
CAUTION: 4WD mode switch to 2WD. lead to poor driveability, reduced fuel econ-
If the warning light is still on after the above omy, and damage to the engine control
. Running the engine with the engine oil system, which may affect the vehicle’s war-
pressure warning light illuminated could operations, have your vehicle checked by a
NISSAN dealer as soon as possible. ranty coverage.
cause serious damage to the engine.
. The engine oil pressure warning light is
not designed to indicate a low oil level. Low fuel warning light Master warning light (if equipped)
The oil level should be checked using the D23A131129-98A780C9-A3F9-45A4-9CE8-8C23D4C61237 D23A131129-51CB32D6-7FE9-4CBE-A710-7584FA819D77
dipstick. (See “Engine oil” (P.8-9).) The low fuel warning light illuminates when the When the ignition switch is in the “ON” position,
fuel level in the tank is getting low. Refuel as the master warning light illuminates if any of
soon as it is convenient, preferably before the the following are displayed on the vehicle
Four-Wheel Drive (4WD) warning fuel gauge reaches the empty (0) position. information display.
light (4WD model) There will be a small reserve of fuel remain- . No Key Detected warning (if equipped)
GUID-5089F54D-2AC8-4F01-8A7E-76FA376EE652 ing in the tank when the fuel gauge reaches . Shift to Park warning (Automatic Transmis-
When the ignition switch is in the “ON” position, the empty (0) position.
the Four-Wheel Drive (4WD) warning light sion (AT) models)
illuminates. After starting the engine, the 4WD . Key ID Incorrect warning (if equipped)
warning light turns off. Malfunction warning light (red) (if . Release Parking Brake warning
If the 4WD system malfunctions or the revolu- equipped) . Low fuel warning
D23A131129-0E567A9E-4568-4221-927E-D35D93D9B087
tion or radius of the front and the rear wheel . Door open warning
When the ignition switch is placed in the “ON”
differs, the warning light will either remain position, the malfunction warning light illumi- . Low Washer warning (if equipped)
illuminated or blink. (See “Four-Wheel Drive nates in red. This means that the system is . Key System Error warning (if equipped)
(4WD)” (P.5-17).) operational. After starting the engine, the . Low Oil Pressure warning (if equipped)
warning light turns off. . 4WD Error (if equipped)
CAUTION: For the orange Malfunction Indicator Light . Shipping Mode On Push Storage Fuse
. If the 4WD warning light illuminates or (MIL), see “Malfunction Indicator Light (MIL)” warning (if equipped)
blinks while driving, reduce the vehicle (P.2-18) for details. . Headlight System Error warning (if
speed and have your vehicle checked by If the malfunction warning light (red) illumi- equipped)
a NISSAN dealer as soon as possible. nates continuously while the engine is running, . Automatic Transmission (AT) Error warning
. If the Four-Wheel Drive (4WD) warning it may indicate an engine control system (Automatic Transmission (AT) models)
light turns on when driving on dry hard malfunction. Have your vehicle inspected by a . Parking Sensor Error (if equipped)
surface roads: NISSAN dealer. You do not need to have your See “Vehicle information display (models with
vehicle towed to the dealer. color display)” (P.2-20).
— in the 4H position, shift the 4WD mode
switch to 2WD.
system is operational.
Front fog light indicator light (if Hill descent control system ON If the Malfunction Indicator Light illuminates or
equipped) indicator light (if equipped) blinks while the engine is running, it may
D23A131129-8A2C070E-8395-49A8-AA90-84EEBFB3159A D23A131129-EF25455E-E240-4499-AA83-B923F6BD3E7E
The front fog light indicator light illuminates When the ignition switch is in the “ON” position indicate that the engine control system is not
when the front fog lights are on. (See “Fog light the hill descent control system on indicator functioning properly and may need servicing.
switch” (P.2-36).) light illuminates briefly and then turns off. This Have the system checked, and if necessary
indicates that the hill descent control system is repaired, by a NISSAN dealer promptly.
operational. Precautions:
Glow plug indicator light (if D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
equipped) The light illuminates when the hill descent To reduce or avoid possible damage to the
GUID-B0711962-218E-4EF3-93A0-8BC3A0BFC4E6 control system is activated. engine control system when the MIL blinks:
YD25DDTi engine model:
D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
If the hill descent control switch is on and the . Avoid driving at speeds above 70 km/h (43
When the ignition switch is in the “ON” position, indicator light blinks, the system is not en- MPH).
the glow plug indicator light illuminates and gaged. . Avoid sudden acceleration or deceleration.
turns off after the glow plugs have warmed up. If the indicator light does not illuminate or blink . Avoid going up steep uphill grades.
If the glow plugs have already warmed up, the when the hill descent control switch is on, the . Avoid carrying or towing unnecessary
glow plug indicator flashes briefly and then system may not be functioning properly. Have loads.
turns off. the system checked by a NISSAN dealer.
For additional information, see “Hill descent
YS23DDT/DDTT engine model:
D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8 control system” (P.5-25).
Rear fog light indicator light (if
When the ignition switch is in the “ON” position equipped)
GUID-14EF9FDD-A97C-48D3-91C7-20742DCF2F53
(models without Intelligent Key system) or
when the engine is started (models with Malfunction Indicator Light (MIL) The rear fog light indicator light illuminates
Intelligent Key system), the glow plug indicator
D23A131129-0B4283D4-EF4C-4DE4-A781-0CEEC7D95F90 when the rear fog light turns on. (See “Fog light
light illuminates and turns off after the glow switch” (P.2-36).)
CAUTION:
plugs have warmed up.
If the engine is already warmed up, the glow . Continuing vehicle operation without Security indicator light (if
plug indicator light may not illuminate. proper servicing of the engine control equipped)
system could lead to poor driveability, D23A131129-C74EBAC9-9741-4A50-811A-6EB642B9C33A
reduced fuel economy, and damage to The security indicator light blinks when the
High beam indicator light the engine control system, which may ignition switch is in the “ACC”, “OFF” or “LOCK”
D23A131129-FEF4DDF3-7F73-4905-A057-45AC536CD27A affect the vehicle’s warranty coverage. position. This function indicates that the secur-
The high beam indicator light illuminates when ity system equipped on the vehicle is opera-
the headlight high beam is on. The indicator . Incorrect setting of the engine control
system may lead to non-compliance of tional.
turns off when the low beam is selected. (See
“Headlight and turn signal switch” (P.2-33).) local and national emission laws and If the security system is malfunctioning, this
regulations. light will remain on while the ignition switch is
in the “ON” position. (See “Security system” (P.3-
When the ignition switch is in the “ON” position, 15) for additional information.)
the Malfunction Indicator Light (MIL) illumi-
nates. After starting the engine, the MIL turns
off. This indicates that the engine control
JVI0899X
JVI1207X
1. Engine start operation indicator (if 4. No Key Detected warning (if switch ? ignition switch position is turned to
equipped for Automatic Transmission equipped) “ON”) ? PUSH warning ? (Push the ignition
D23A131129-F64EE7FA-F59A-44CE-8AE4-1BC5155B33B9 switch ? ignition switch position is turned to
(AT) models)
D23A131129-3685162D-5526-4230-9F59-B5077835AD1A This warning appears when the door is closed “OFF”)
This indicator appears when the shift lever is in with the Intelligent Key left outside the vehicle
the “P” (Park) position. and the ignition switch in the “ON” position. 8. Key Battery low warning (if equipped)
D23A131129-9D00606A-213C-41ED-9792-F3E66A959317
Make sure that the Intelligent Key is inside the This warning appears when the Intelligent Key
This indicator means that the engine will start vehicle.
by pushing the ignition switch with the brake battery is running out of power.
pedal depressed. You can start the engine See “Intelligent Key system” (P.3-7) for more If this warning appears, replace the battery
directly in any position of the ignition switch. details. with a new one. (See “Intelligent Key battery”
5. Key reminder warning (if equipped) (P.8-23).)
2. Engine start operation indicator (if GUID-A5CEDBCD-C07C-4EEE-AD85-F5F97AF93465
equipped for Manual Transmission (MT) This warning appears if the driver’s side door is 9. Engine start operation for Intelligent
models) opened while the key is left in the ignition Key system indicator (if equipped)
GUID-C73E8D84-D7EB-48E9-B446-FC06DCF36A61 D23A131129-EFD2075E-835F-41D3-8E8C-317F0E5CA58F
switch and ignition switch is in the “ACC”, “OFF”
This indicator means that the engine will start or “LOCK” position. Remove the key and take it This indicator appears when the Intelligent Key
by pushing the ignition switch with the clutch with you when leaving the vehicle. battery is running out of power and when the
pedal depressed. You can start the engine Intelligent Key system and vehicle are not
directly in any position of the ignition switch. 6. Shift to Park warning (if equipped for normally communicated.
You can also start the engine by pushing the AT models)D23A131129-E6B0B268-3E58-4764-B127-EE6C672D5BD3
If this indicator appears, touch the ignition
ignition switch with the brake pedal depressed This warning appears when the ignition switch switch with the Intelligent Key while depressing
when the shift lever is in the “N” (Neutral) is pushed to stop the engine with the shift lever the brake pedal. (See “Intelligent Key battery
position. in any position except the “P” (Park) position. discharge” (P.5-12).)
3. Steering lock release malfunction If this warning appears, move the shift lever to 10. Key ID Incorrect warning (if
indicator D23A131129-3D338252-160E-4B81-974D-797F205A8E7B
(if equipped) the “P” (Park) position or push the ignition equipped) GUID-C2BBF5FC-9AFE-4276-B8C4-D23476F0631C
switch to the “ON” position.
This indicator appears when the steering wheel This warning appears when the ignition switch
cannot be released from the “LOCK” position. An inside warning chime will also sound. (See is placed from the “LOCK” position and the
“Intelligent Key system” (P.3-7).) Intelligent Key cannot be recognized by the
If this indicator appears, push the ignition
switch while lightly turning the steering wheel system. You cannot start the engine with an
7. “PUSH” warning (if equipped for AT unregistered key. Use the registered Intelligent
right and left. models)D23A131129-DD853589-E798-4C0B-86E4-3283F8AACCA0 Key.
See “Steering lock” (P.5-11). This warning appears when the shift lever is See “Intelligent Key system” (P.3-7).
moved to the “P” (Park) position with the
ignition switch in the “ACC” position after the
Shift to Park warning appears.
To push the ignition switch to the “OFF”
position, perform the following procedure:
Shift to Park warning? (Move the shift lever to
“P”) ? PUSH warning ? (Push the ignition
24. TimeD23A131129-A160B3D2-0964-4299-878F-2A4A1BE068BA
for a driver break? indicator 28. Automatic Transmission (AT) park MAINTENANCE INDICATORS
D23A131129-43791F7F-89DA-41B7-94FC-AEF196BEE4BB
This indicator appears when the set “Timer warning (ATGUID-23B23AF5-EB44-49DD-8264-52FBC0F841FA
models)
Alert” alarm activates. You can set the time for This warning indicates that the Automatic
up to 6 hours. (See “Trip computer” (P.2-25).) Transmission (AT) parking function is not en-
gaged. If the transfer control is not secured in
25. Cruise control indicator (if any driving position while the AT shift lever is in
equipped)D23A131129-8F42A74C-6268-4C08-A24B-445326ED67FA the “P” (Park) position, the transmission will
This indicator shows the cruise control system disengage and the wheels will not lock.
status. The status is shown by the color. For 4WD model: If the ATP warning appears
See “Cruise control” (P.5-26) for details. with the shift lever in the “P” (Park) position,
shift the Four-Wheel Drive (4WD) mode
26. Automatic Transmission (AT) posi- switch to the 2WD, 4H or 4LO position again
tion indicator (AT models) with the shift lever in the N (Neutral) position.
GUID-83946B01-351C-4468-980B-D9784C2B6F44
(See “Four-Wheel Drive (4WD)” (P.5-17).)
This indicator shows the automatic shift posi-
tion.
WARNING:
In the manual shift mode, when the transmis-
sion does not shift to the selected gear due to a If the 4WD mode indicator (see “4WD mode
transmission protection mode, the AT position indicator” (P.5-21)) is “OFF” or the ATP warn-
indicator will blink and a chime will sound. ing light is “ON”, this indicates that the
For further details, see “Driving with Automatic automatic transmission P (Park) position will
Transmission (AT)” (P.5-14). not function and could result in the vehicle
moving unexpectedly, causing serious per-
27. Automatic Transmission (AT) Error sonal injury or property damage. Always set
warning (AT GUID-7C968266-263D-470F-95FD-F0517FE2D62A
models) the parking brake.
If the Automatic Transmission (AT) Error warn-
ing appears while the engine is running, or 29. Parking Sensor Error warning (if
while driving, it may indicate that the AT is not equipped) GUID-F46590C5-A881-4EE3-91F7-A575A4F57B63
functioning properly and may need servicing. This warning appears when the parking sensor
Have the system checked, and if necessary (sonar) system is not functioning properly. If the
repaired, by a NISSAN dealer promptly. warning appears, have the system checked by
a NISSAN dealer.
JVI1239X
. If the amount of fuel added is small, the Elapsed time and trip odometer (km or Trip odometer:
D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
display just before the ignition switch is mile) The trip odometer mode shows the total
placed in the “OFF” position may continue D23A131129-F5274350-04B0-4656-A93C-F7C274A8E2DE
distance that the vehicle has been driven since
to be displayed. the last reset. Resetting is done by pushing the
. When driving uphill or rounding curves, the or for longer than 1 second. (The
fuel in the tank shifts, which may momen- elapsed time is also reset at the same time.)
tarily change the display.
When the or is pushed and held
Speed and Average (km/h or MPH) for more than 3 seconds, the average speed,
D23A131129-E5575A81-772B-4506-AA29-20E6873DB21C the elapsed time, the trip odometer, the current
and average fuel consumption will be reset.
JVI1728X
Speed: D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
The (digital) speed shows the current speed at
which the vehicle is travelling. JVI1109X
Average speed:
D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
The average speed shows the average vehicle WAC0109X Current fuelD23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
consumption:
speed since the last reset. Resetting is done by Type B The current fuel consumption mode shows the
pushing the or for longer than 1 current fuel consumption.
Elapsed time:
D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
second. Average fuel consumption:
The elapsed time mode shows the time since D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
When the or is pushed and held the last reset. The displayed time can be reset The average fuel consumption mode shows
for more than 3 seconds, the average speed, by pushing the or for longer than the average fuel consumption since the last
the elapsed time, the trip odometer, the current 1 second. (The trip odometer is also reset at the reset. Resetting is done by pushing the
and average fuel consumption will be reset. same time.) or for longer than 1 second.
The display is updated every 30 seconds. For When the or is pushed and held
the first 30 seconds after a reset, the display for more than 3 seconds, the average speed,
shows “----”. the elapsed time, the trip odometer, the current
and average fuel consumption will be reset.
The display is updated every 30 seconds. At — Volume information display when the ignition
about the first 500 m (1/3 mile) after a reset, the Select this submenu to change the switch is placed in the “ON” position.
display shows “——”. parking sensor (sonar) buzzer volume. . ECO Drive Report (if equipped)
— Range There are 2 submenus under the ECO Drive
Navigation (if equipped) Report menu.
GUID-F2C7E593-9295-40FC-B43A-E7CC93AF3FCF Select this submenu to change the
When the route guidance is set in the naviga- parking sensor (sonar) detection range. — Display
tion system, this item shows the navigation
Select this submenu to enable/disable
route information. Clock: D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8 the ECO Drive Report in the vehicle
There are following submenus under the clock information display.
Compass (ifGUID-8C007645-62E8-499B-B5A3-36630D10B5F8
equipped) menu, depending on the equipment of each — View History
This display indicates the heading direction of vehicle.
the vehicle. Select this submenu to reset the past
. Set Clock in NAVI (if equipped) history of the fuel economy and the best
Audio (if equipped) See “How to use SETUP button” (P.4-6), the fuel economy. See “ECO drive report”
GUID-9C8C6902-A3DA-47A5-9030-36EE54E0F500
separate Navigation Owner’s Manual or the (P.5-28).
The audio mode shows the status of audio separate NissanConnect Owner’s Manual. . Welcome Effect
information.
. Set Clock in Audio (if equipped) Select this submenu to enable/disable the
Warning D23A131129-8A601D7D-5F4F-4C2C-9303-C735397A7F76
check See “How to use SETUP button” (P.4-6), display effect and the dial and pointer
“Audio main operation” (P.4-39), “Audio effect described below to on or off.
The present warnings are displayed. If no
warning is present, “No Warning” is displayed. main operation” (P.4-45), “Audio main op- — Display Effect
eration” (P.4-52), “Audio main operation” The welcome screen display appears
Settings (P.4-58), “Audio main operation” (P.4-64) or when the ignition switch is turned on.
D23A131129-17EBA149-8B23-4234-891B-D6E3FB8B7624
the separate NissanConnect Owner’s Man- — Dial Effect
Settings cannot be made while driving.
ual.
The and ENTER switch is used in the The indicator needles sweep in the
. Set Clock (if equipped) meters when the engine is started.
setting mode.
Select this submenu to adjust the time on
Use the switch to select a menu. the clock. Vehicle Settings:
D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
Push ENTER to decide a menu. . 12H/24H (if equipped) There are following submenus under the Ve-
Select this submenu to choose the clock hicle settings menu.
Driver Assistance (if equipped):
D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8 format between 12-hour and 24-hour. . Lighting (if equipped)
Select this submenu to change the status or
Meter Settings: There are 2 submenus under the Lighting
turn on or off any of the systems displayed in D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8 menu.
the Parking Aids menu. There are following submenus under the Meter
— Auto Room Lamp
. Parking Aids settings menu.
Select this submenu to enable/disable
There are 3 submenus under the Parking . Main Menu Selection the auto room lamp feature.
Aids menu. Select this submenu to enable/disable the The interior lights will be ON if any door
— Sensor items that are displayed. is unlocked when the auto room lamp is
Select this submenu to enable/disable . Body Color enabled.
the parking sensor (sonar). Select this submenu to change the color of
the vehicle that displays in the vehicle
OIL CONTROL SYSTEM (if equipped for When the ignition switch is in the “ON” position, — The oil replacement indicator is dis-
diesel engine model) engine oil information is displayed. played in the vehicle information dis-
GUID-1B546433-AA9C-4E04-AA9E-D90FAB0ED0F1
Engine oil information informs the distance to play.
oil change, oil level indication and malfunction . The engine oil should be changed before
of oil level sensor. the distance to oil change reaches 0 km
(0 miles). Continued driving after the
1. Distance to oil change
GUID-90CF766F-BDC3-489F-9398-606B168A3A25
distance to oil change reaches 0 km (0
The distance to oil change is displayed if the miles) may result in reduced engine
distance to oil change is less than 1,500 km performance.
(930 miles). . The Diesel Particulate Filter (DPF) may
also become saturated because regen-
2. Oil replacement indicator
GUID-36E5CFFE-51E7-4707-BBBB-50D92F37F7CA
eration is restricted once the distance to
When the set mileage approaches, the engine oil change reaches 0 km (0 miles).
oil replacement indicator will appear on the Have the vehicle inspected by a NISSAN
display. After the oil is changed, reset the dealer if the above condition occurs.
distance to oil change. The oil replacement
indicator will not be reset automatically. To . The oil change interval will reduce faster
reset this indicator, see “Settings” (P.2-27). with certain types of driving, especially at
row speeds in urban conditions.
The distance to oil change interval cannot be
adjusted manually. The distance to oil change 3. Low levelGUID-C3820109-0CB1-4B08-8F40-A79450C5D7C0
reminder
interval is set automatically. If the low level indicator is displayed, the engine
oil level is low. If the low level reminder is
CAUTION: displayed, check the level using the engine oil
dipstick. (See “Engine oil” (P.8-9).)
. If the oil replacement indicator is dis-
played, change the engine oil as soon as
possible. Operating your vehicle with CAUTION:
deteriorated oil can damage the engine. The oil level should be checked regularly
. Never perform reset if the engine oil was using the engine oil dipstick. Operating with
not changed. Always visit a NISSAN dealer an insufficient amount of oil can damage the
to perform the engine oil change includ- engine and such damage is not covered by
ing an oil filter change and the reset. the warranty.
NOTE:
. It is not possible to undo the reset.
. Resetting the oil change distance is only
possible when:
— The distance to oil change is displayed
JVI1244X in the vehicle information display.
JVI1031X
distance to oil change, oil level indication and for more than 3 seconds within 5 seconds
oil level sensor malfunctions. of placing the ignition switch in the “ON”
To reset the oil control system, push and hold position.
the trip computer mode switch for more The wrench symbol and the distance
than 3 seconds when the engine oil informa- will start flashing.
tion is displayed. 2. While the display is flashing, push and hold
the trip computer mode switch for more
1. Distance to oil change
GUID-4AC1BE84-29D5-4E96-9176-C0D9DCE26D03 than 3 seconds to enter the adjustment
When the ignition switch is placed in the “ON” mode.
position, the distance to oil change is displayed.
If adjusting the distance from zero (0): Push
2. Oil replacement indicator the trip computer mode switch . The
GUID-29D75429-E605-47D5-AF0E-8F9796696072 default distance to oil change will be
restored.
CAUTION:
3. Turn the trip computer mode switch
If the oil replacement indicator is displayed, clockwise or counterclockwise to increase
change the engine oil as soon as possible. or decrease the interval. Each turn in-
Operating your vehicle with oil that has creases or decreases the interval by 1,000
deteriorated can damage the engine. km (500 miles).
When the distance to oil change information If no further action is taken, the display will
showing zero (0) or less is displayed: When the switch to the oil level indication and the new
ignition switch is placed in the “ON” position, a interval will be set.
wrench symbol blinks and the distance to oil To cancel oil change reminder:
change information showing zero (0) is dis- D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
played for approximately 5 seconds. 1. Push and hold the trip computer mode
switch for more than 3 seconds while the
Setting distance to oil change:
D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8 wrench symbol and distance to oil
The distance to oil change interval can be change information are displayed.
adjusted or disabled using the trip computer The wrench symbol and the distance
mode switch . will start flashing.
Refer to the separate maintenance booklet for 2. While the display is flashing, push the trip
the appropriate distance to oil change interval. computer mode switch again to enter
To adjust oil change interval: the adjustment mode.
D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
1. Push and hold the trip computer mode 3. Turn the trip computer mode switch
switch for more than 3 seconds while the counterclockwise until the interval reads 0.
JVI0438X
wrench symbol and distance to oil If no further action is taken, the display will
When the ignition switch is in the “ON” position, change information are displayed. switch to the oil level indication and the oil
engine oil information is displayed. If adjusting the distance from zero (0): Push change reminder is cancelled.
Engine oil information informs you of the and hold the trip computer mode switch No wrench symbol or distance will be displayed
position
D23A131129-B60F4D75-B29F-408F-8E76-A8B97DDFB986
The position turns on the front clearance, SIC3785
instrument panel, tail and license plate lights.
To turn on the high beam, push the lever JVI0477X
position
D23A131129-4DAB4169-1827-49E8-B896-70450926F885
towards the front position .
The position turns on the headlights in To turn off the high beam, return the lever to The headlight aiming control operates when
addition to the other lights. the neutral position . the ignition switch is in the “ON” position and
the headlight is on to allow the headlight axis
To flash the headlights, pull the lever towards to be adjusted according to the driving condi-
the rearmost position . The headlights can be tion.
flashed even when the headlights are not on.
When driving with no heavy load/luggage or
If equipped, when the lever is pulled towards driving on a flat road, select the normal position
the rearmost position after the ignition “0”.
switch is placed in the “OFF” or “LOCK” position,
the headlight will turn on and stay on for 30 If the number of occupants and load/luggage
in the vehicle changes, the headlight axis may For Malaysia Double Cab: TURN SIGNAL SWITCH
D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8 D23A131129-E756AA92-11EB-46FA-A0DF-E301D3A32C48
become higher than normal.
Number Number Weight of load
If the vehicle is traveling on a hilly road, the Switch
of front of rear in luggage
headlights may directly shine on the rearview posi-
seat oc- seat oc- compartment
and outside mirrors of a vehicle ahead or the tion
cupants cupants
windshield of an oncoming vehicle, which may
obscure other drivers’ vision. No oc- No load
0 1 or 2
cupants
To adjust to the proper aiming height, turn the
switch accordingly. The higher the number, 1 2 3 No load
designated on the switch, the lower the head- 2 - - -
light axis.
Approximately
Select the switch position by referring to the No oc- 614 kg (1,354 lb)
following samples. 3 1 or 2 cupants Approximately
or 3 805 kg (1,775 lb)
For Malaysia Single Cab:
D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
SIC3813 SIC4067
Type B Type D
NOTE:
Be sure to apply the parking brake when you
use the cargo light switch, otherwise the
cargo light will not turn on.
JVI1105X
Type A
Washer operation
D23A131129-5268D467-1F46-4E5E-BBC6-BD09FA5B4906
To operate the washer, pull the lever toward
the back of the vehicle until the desired
amount of washer fluid is spread on the wind-
shield. The wiper will automatically operate
JVI1222X several times. SIC3537
Type B Type A
JVI0026X JVI0853X
Type C Type B
The windshield wiper and washer operate
when the ignition switch is in the “ON” position.
Wiper operation
D23A131129-6DF76079-383B-4207-8A41-F4630E87AB5B
The lever position “INT” operates the wiper
intermittently.
The intermittent operation can be adjusted by
turning the adjustment control knob, (longer)
or (shorter) . (Type A or Type B)
The lever position “LO” operates the wiper at
low speed.
JVI1022X
The lever position “HI” operates the wiper at
Type C
high speed.
The rear window defogger switch operates
HORN WINDOWS
D23A131129-558C3494-5C96-43AB-A3EA-176750978BB3 D23A131129-037EA0C9-B46E-4467-B8E3-89747E9741CA
when the ignition switch is in the “ON” position. MANUAL WINDOWS (if equipped)
GUID-21B7E561-2FC2-47B1-B051-EBA09B4B6B38
The defogger is used to reduce the moisture,
fog or frost on the rear window and outside
rearview mirror (if equipped) surfaces to im-
prove the rear view.
When the defogger switch is pushed, the
indicator light illuminates and the rear
window defogger operates for approximately
15 minutes. After the preset time has passed,
the defogger will turn off automatically.
To turn off manually, push the defogger switch JVI0851X
again.
The horn switch operates regardless of the SIC4435
CAUTION: ignition switch position except when the bat-
tery is discharged. The side windows can be opened or closed
. When operating the defogger continu- by turning the hand crank on each door.
ously, be sure to start the engine. Other- When the horn switch is pushed and held, the
wise, it may cause the battery to horn will sound. Releasing the horn switch will POWER WINDOWS (if equipped)
cease the horn sound. D23A131129-019EDE71-1D6E-4678-9A74-B55ABF424541
discharge.
. When cleaning the inner side of the WARNING:
window, be careful not to scratch or . Make sure that all passengers have their
damage the electrical conductors on the hands, etc. inside the vehicle before
surface of the window. operating the power windows.
. To help avoid risk of injury or death
through unintended operation of the
vehicle and or its systems, including
entrapment in windows or inadvertent
door lock activation, do not leave chil-
dren, people who require the assistance
of others or pets unattended in your
vehicle. Additionally, the temperature in-
side a closed vehicle on a warm day can
quickly become high enough to cause a
significant risk of injury or death to
people and pets.
The power windows operate when the ignition
switch is in the “ON” position.
To open a window, push down the power
window switch.
Instruments and controls 2-39
To close a window, pull up the power window sponding window. Auto-reverse function:
D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
switch. When the passenger’s windows lock button on
the driver’s switch is pushed in, the passenger’s WARNING:
Driver’s window switch
D23A131129-A9BD29BC-A482-48F5-905A-77C13C896BD7 switch cannot be operated.
There is a small distance just before the
Automatic function closed position which cannot be detected.
D23A131129-C93B5CE7-0AAF-432B-93BD-BCF6558519A9 Make sure that all passengers have their
hands, etc. inside the vehicle before closing
the windows.
The auto-reverse function enables a window to
automatically reverse when something is
caught in the window as it is closing by the
automatic function. When the control unit
detects an obstacle, the window will be low-
ered immediately.
JVI1223X
Depending on the environment or driving
The driver’s switch, the main switch, can conditions, the auto-reverse function may
control all windows. JVI1224X activate if an impact or load similar to some-
thing being caught in the window occurs.
Locking passenger’s windows: The automatic function is available for the
D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
When the lock button is pushed in, the
switch that has an mark on its surface. If the window does not close automa-
passenger’s windows cannot be operated. The automatic function enables a window to tically D23A131129-7697C7D0-FDC0-4911-8630-F93CB6220D37
fully open or close without holding the switch If the power window automatic function (clos-
To cancel the passenger’s windows lock, push
down or up. ing only) does not operate properly, perform
the lock button again.
To fully open the window, push the power the following procedure to initialize the power
Passenger’s window switch
D23A131129-5AA34D81-AF36-43F5-98DA-ACC04400FDB8
window switch down to the second detent and window system.
release the switch. To fully close the window, 1. Start the engine.
pull the power window switch up to the second
detent and release the switch. The switch does 2. Close the door.
not have to be held during window operation. 3. Open the window completely by operating
To stop the window open/close operation the power window switch.
during the automatic function, push down or 4. Pull the power window switch and hold it to
pull up the switch in opposite directions. close the window, and then hold the switch
more than 3 seconds after the window is
closed completely.
5. Release the power window switch. Operate
the window by the automatic function to
SIC4523 confirm the initialization is complete.
If the power window automatic function does
The passenger’s switch can control its corre-
CAUTION:
. Remove water drops, snow, ice or sand
from the sunroof before opening.
. Do not place any heavy objects on the
JVI1209X sunroof or surrounding area.
AUTOMATIC SUNROOF
D23A131129-E219D963-1EA9-4B99-A687-768FB5513A7A
JVI1210X
JVI0614X
WARNING:
The sunroof operates when the ignition switch
. Make sure that all passengers have their
is in the “ON” position.
hands, etc. inside the vehicle before
operating the auto slide back window.
. Never leave children or adults who would
normally require the support of others
alone in the vehicle. They could unknow-
POWER OUTLETS
D23A131129-71B10566-178F-44B7-9586-EB31A2CB2FF1
Sunshade switch to the CLOSE position.
D23A131129-3A47073D-14CC-4A80-A445-AB7EB5052AA0
To open or close the sunshade, slide the Depending on the environment or driving
sunshade manually. conditions, the auto-reverse function may
activate if an impact or load similar to some-
The sunshade will open automatically when
thing being caught in the sunroof occurs.
the sunroof is opened. The sunshade needs to
be closed manually by sliding it. If sunroofD23A131129-314045A5-1912-45DE-8238-FA872B8B506E
does not operate
Sunroof D23A131129-8653DAD9-BD28-4DEF-938A-23281964A74D If the sunroof does not operate properly, per-
form the following procedure to initialize the
Tilting: D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8 sunroof operation system.
To tilt up, first close the sunroof, then push the 1. If the sunroof is open, close it fully by
switch to the TILT UP position and release it; JVI1023X
repeatedly pushing the sunroof switch to
it need not be held. To tilt down the sunroof, the close position to tilt the sunroof up. Instrument panel (upper)
push the switch to the TILT DOWN position .
2. Push and hold the switch to the close
Sliding: D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
position .
To fully open or close the sunroof, push the 3. Release the sunroof switch after the sun-
switch to the OPEN or CLOSE position and roof moves slightly up and down.
release it; it need not be held. The roof will
4. Push and hold the switch to the open
automatically open or close all the way. To stop
position to fully tilt the sunroof down.
the roof, push the switch once more while it is
opening or closing. 5. Check if the sunroof switch operates nor-
mally.
Auto-reverse function
D23A131129-DD9B3F5F-8338-4590-97C0-F7BB96B5AEE4 If the sunroof does not operate properly after
performing the procedure above, have your JVI1024X
WARNING: vehicle checked by a NISSAN dealer.
Instrument panel (lower)
There is a small distance just before the
closed position which cannot be detected.
Make sure that all passengers have their
hands, etc. inside the vehicle before closing
the sunroof.
The auto-reverse function enables the sunroof
to automatically reverse when something is
caught in the sunroof as it is closing. When the
control unit detects an obstacle, the sunroof
will open immediately.
If the sunroof cannot be closed automatically
when the auto reverse function activates due
to a malfunction, push and hold the sunroof
CAUTION:
. Do not leave a power cable on the
instrument panel in direct sunlight. The
surface of the instrument panel may
become very hot resulting in damage to
the power cable.
. Do not put a liquid container near the
power outlet. Spilled contents may get
into the power outlet and can result in a
malfunction.
JVI1025X JVI1585X
. The outlet and plug may be hot during or
Console box (if equipped) Console box
The power outlet is used for powering electrical immediately after use.
accessories. . This power outlet is not designed for use
Use the cutout between the lid and the with a cigarette lighter unit.
console box to use a powering cable with the . Do not use accessories that exceed a
console box lid closed. combined power draw of 12 volt, 120W
(10A) (except for truck box power outlet)
or 12 volt, 240W (20A) (for truck box
power outlet). Do not use double adap-
ters or more than one electrical acces-
sory.
. Use this power outlet with the engine
JVI1211X running to avoid discharging the vehicle
Truck box (if equipped) battery.
. Avoid using when the air conditioner,
headlights or rear window defogger is
on (if equipped).
JVI1110X . Push the plug in as far as it will go. If good
Instrument panel (upper) contact is not made, the plug may over-
heat or the internal temperature fuse
WARNING: may blow.
Do not place any objects on the instrument . Before inserting or disconnecting a plug,
panel. Such objects may become dangerous be sure that the electrical accessory
projectiles and cause injury if a supplemental being used is turned OFF.
JVI1584X air bag inflates (if equipped). . When not in use, be sure to close the cap.
Instrument panel (lower) Do not allow water or any liquid to
contact the outlet.
STORAGE
D23A131129-E4DBC035-E53E-4441-88DA-A00F0E88CB21
To open the console box lid, push up the knob CUP HOLDERS
WARNING: and pull up the lid. D23A131129-254417BA-3214-47CC-8182-9A8F0C55B921
. The storages should not be used while To close, push the lid down until the lock WARNING:
driving so that the full attention may be latches.
given to vehicle operation. The driver must not remove or insert cups
SUNGLASSES HOLDER (if equipped) into the cup holder while driving so that full
. Keep the storage lids closed while driving D23A131129-BE56EC99-6D94-411E-957E-594FAF359F97
attention may be given to vehicle operation.
to help prevent injury in an accident or a
sudden stop.
CAUTION:
GLOVE BOX
D23A131129-EFAE8038-23E5-4DB0-AA90-2DED70AADF90 . Avoid abrupt starting and braking espe-
cially when the cup holder is being used
to prevent spilling the contents. If the
contents are hot, they could scald you or
your passengers.
. Use only soft cups in the cup holder. Hard
objects can injure you in an accident.
JVI0619X
Front (if equipped)
D23A131129-22302515-0798-47D5-BC03-97795F02E8AB
To open the sunglasses holder, push and
release. Only store one pair of sunglasses in
the holder.
JVI1102X
CAUTION:
. Do not use for anything other than JVI1028X
sunglasses. To open the cup holder, pull the holder from
. Do not leave sunglasses in the sun- the instrument panel.
glasses holder while parking in direct When the cup holder is not in use, keep it
sunlight. The heat may damage the stored.
sunglasses.
JVI1026X
Center console (front separate seat Rear seat (if equipped for Double Cab Soft bottle holder
D23A131129-61EFB93A-87D5-44A0-BA9E-DFAAA14CFFC7
models) D23A131129-176305EB-F561-4D12-99D4-03CC0ADFFC99 models) D23A131129-82BC5D4D-DA40-4805-B5B0-4718375819F3
JVI1241X
JVI1027X JVI1242X Example
The front and rear (if equipped) soft bottle
The cup holder for rear seats is located on the holders are located on the doors.
Lower instrument panel (front bench rear foot well area.
seat models)GUID-EF2EEC34-1611-4D80-8D4D-CC8E7E0E3313
To use the cup holder, pull it down . CAUTION:
When the cup holder is not in use, keep it stored . Do not use bottle holder for any other
. objects that could be thrown about in the
vehicle and possibly injure people during
sudden braking or an accident.
. Do not use bottle holder for open liquid
containers.
JVI1212X
JVI1243X
JVI1103X
SUN VISORS
D23A131129-9FAD8DB4-278F-4DB9-847D-80BB3C4BAFC1
Do not apply any load directly to the roof side CARD HOLDER (if equipped)
GUID-32AFDC78-240B-4C55-9EE0-CB43786EDE9F
rails. Cross bars must be installed before
applying load/cargo/luggage to the roof of
the vehicle. Genuine NISSAN accessory cross
bars may be available through a NISSAN dealer.
Contact a NISSAN dealer for additional infor-
mation.
The service load capacity for the roof side rails
is 56 kg (125 lb), however do not exceed the
accessory cross bars load capacity.
WARNING:
. Always install the cross bars onto the JVI1240X
roof side rails before loading cargo of any
kind. Loading cargo directly onto the roof Slide a card in the card holder .
side rails or the vehicle’s roof may cause
vehicle damage.
. Drive extra carefully when the vehicle is
loaded at or near the cargo carrying
capacity, especially if the significant por-
tion of that load is carried on the roof
rack.
. Heavy loading of the roof rack has the
potential to affect the vehicle stability
and handling during sudden or unusual SIC2872
handling maneuvers.
. Roof rack load should be evenly distrib- 1. To block out glare from the front, swing
uted. down the sun visor .
. Do not exceed maximum roof rack load 2. To block glare from the side, remove the
weight capacity. sun visor from the center mount and swing
it to the side .
. Properly secure all cargo with ropes or
straps to help prevent it from sliding or
shifting. In a sudden stop or collision,
unsecured cargo could cause personal
injury.
INTERIOR LIGHTS
D23A131129-FA9338D7-11A2-43A6-8438-0B351CFC6054
CONSOLE LIGHT (if equipped) Type B
CAUTION: GUID-BE418176-8CF4-429E-996B-B8C81B5AA92C GUID-631C4AC0-D45C-48D7-BB40-322070A06A68
JVI1038X SIC4572
The console light will turn on whenever the Operate the map light switch to turn the map
clearance lights or headlights are illuminated. light on or off.
: ON position
MAP LIGHTS
D23A131129-9A3E5C9F-5F2F-4425-8052-22F0EA398925 : OFF position
Type A GUID-6EE2A1AB-A4D0-4841-A834-CEEC7B93BA7C MAP LIGHT CONTROL SWITCH (if
JVI1037X equipped) GUID-C4604864-748A-4907-85B7-53F512975704
The interior light can be turned ON
regardless of door position. The light will
go off after a period of time unless the
ignition switch is placed in the “ON”
position when any door is opened.
The interior lights can be set to operate
when the doors are opened. To turn off
the interior lights when a door open, push
the switch, the interior lights will not
JVI1039X
illuminate, regardless of door position.
The lights will go off when the ignition Push the button to turn the map lights on. To SIC4573
switch is placed in the “ON” position, or turn them off, push the button again.
the driver’s door is closed and locked. The The map lights control switch has three posi-
lights will also go off after a period of time tions: ON , OFF and center.
when the doors are open.
ON position GUID-4502A2EF-9192-423A-8F0C-9B9C706AFC49 The room light has a three-position switch. any condition.
When the switch is in the “ON” position , the When the switch is in the “ON” position , the
room light illuminates.
REAR PERSONAL LIGHT (if equipped)
GUID-BDBEDFC0-D9C6-412F-B54E-4DD962C48041
map lights will illuminate.
When the switch is in the “*” (Door) position ,
OFF position
GUID-6BC9F6AB-6F4D-4628-8A64-504F73946DD6 the room light illuminates when a door is
When the switch is in the “OFF” position , the opened.
map lights will not illuminate, regardless of any The interior light timer will keep the room light
other condition. on for a period of time when:
Center position
GUID-615F9055-D7CB-4B94-B976-BB56BFA0D832
. The key is removed from the ignition switch
When the switch is in the center position, the with all doors closed (models without
map lights will illuminate under the following Intelligent Key).
conditions: . The ignition switch is placed in the “OFF”
position with all doors closed (models with
. the key is removed from the ignition switch Intelligent Key). SIC3250
— remain on for a period of time. . The driver’s door is unlocked without the
. doors are unlocked by pushing the “UN- key in the ignition switch (models without To turn the rear personal lights on, push the
LOCK” button (model with remote key- Intelligent Key). switch. To turn them off, push the switch again.
less entry system) with the ignition switch . The driver’s door is unlocked when the
in the “LOCK” position VANITY MIRROR LIGHTS (if equipped)
D23A131129-F71B392F-DC48-4C8A-9B29-81919B81501C
ignition switch is in the “LOCK” position
— remain on for a period of time. (models with Intelligent Key).
. any door is opened . The doors are unlocked with the “UN-
— remain on while the door is opened. LOCK” button (model with remote key-
When the door is closed, the lights go less entry system).
off. . The last door is closed without the key in
the ignition switch (models without Intelli-
ROOM LIGHT (if equipped)
D23A131129-CD771C4A-B056-4C39-98B6-0E0DCB44387E gent Key).
The interior light timer will be cancelled when:
. Any door is locked by pushing the “LOCK”
button on the remote controller (if
equipped) with the ignition switch in the SIC3869
“OFF” position.
. Any door is locked by door handle request To access the vanity mirror, pull the sun visor
switch (if equipped) with the ignition switch down and flip open the mirror cover.
in the “OFF” position. The vanity mirror light illuminates when the
. The ignition switch is placed in the “ON” vanity mirror cover is opened. When the cover
position. is closed, the light will turn off.
SIC2489
When the switch is in the “OFF” position , the
room light does not illuminate, regardless of
BATTERYD23A131129-C241DC06-FBF7-4835-95A1-DEC0F43BB5C8
SAVER SYSTEM
The lights will turn off after a period of time
when the lights remain illuminated to prevent
the battery from becoming discharged.
MEMO
Keys .........................................................................................................................
.... 3-2 Security system (if equipped) ..........................................................
.... 3-15
Key (if equipped) ....................................................................................
.... 3-2 Theft warning system (if equipped) ................................. .... 3-15
NISSAN Anti-Theft System (NATS) key NISSAN Anti-Theft System (NATS) ...................................... .... 3-15
(if equipped) ...............................................................................................
.... 3-2 Hood ....................................................................................................................
.... 3-16
Intelligent Key (if equipped) ..........................................................
.... 3-3 Opening hood ....................................................................................
.... 3-17
Doors ......................................................................................................................
.... 3-4 Closing hood .......................................................................................
.... 3-17
Locking with key ....................................................................................
.... 3-4 Fuel-filler lid and cap .............................................................................
.... 3-17
Locking with inside lock knob ....................................................
.... 3-4 Opening fuel-filler lid (if equipped) .................................... .... 3-17
Locking with power door lock switch (if equipped) ..... .... 3-5 Fuel-filler cap ......................................................................................
.... 3-18
Rear access doors (King Cab models) ................................. .... 3-5 Truck box (if equipped) ........................................................................
.... 3-19
Child safety rear door locks (Double Cab models) ..... .... 3-5 Tailgate ....................................................................................................
.... 3-19
Remote keyless entry system (if equipped) ............................ .... 3-6 Tie down hooks (if equipped) ................................................
.... 3-20
Using remote keyless entry system ....................................... .... 3-6 C-Channel system (if equipped) .......................................... .... 3-20
Intelligent Key system (if equipped) ..............................................
.... 3-7 Sport bar (if equipped) ................................................................
.... 3-22
Intelligent Key operating range .................................................
.... 3-8 Steering wheel ............................................................................................
.... 3-23
Using Intelligent Key system ........................................................
.... 3-8 Steering wheel adjustment (if equipped) ..................... .... 3-23
Battery saver system .........................................................................
.... 3-9 Mirrors ................................................................................................................
.... 3-23
Warning and audible reminders .................................................... 3-9 Inside rearview mirror .................................................................
.... 3-23
Troubleshooting guide ..................................................................
.... 3-11 Outside rearview mirrors ..........................................................
.... 3-24
Using remote keyless entry system .................................... .... 3-13 Vanity mirror (if equipped) .......................................................
.... 3-25
Hazard indicator and horn operation ............................... .... 3-13 Parking brake ...............................................................................................
.... 3-25
KEYS
D23A131129-ACCC2553-DC55-48E0-B662-29078F813DF5
A key number plate is supplied with your key. 1. Master key (Molded) (1) one vehicle.
Record the key number on the key number 2. Master key (Plate) (1)
plate/metal tag and keep it in a safe place NISSAN ANTI-THEFT SYSTEM (NATS*)
3. Key number plate (1)
(such as your wallet), NOT IN THE VEHICLE. KEY (if equipped)
GUID-0232DA76-8001-49B1-A511-7B7B4E425213
NISSAN does not record key numbers so it is
very important to keep track of your key
number plate.
A key number is only necessary when you have
lost all keys and do not have one to duplicate
from. If you still have a key, this key can be
duplicated by a NISSAN dealer.
JVP0324X
JVP0085X
1. Master key (with remote controller) (2)
1. NATS key (molded) (2)
2. Key number plate (1)
2. Key number plate (1)
As many as 5 master keys with remote
controller can be registered and used with
one vehicle.
JVP0085X
JVP0324X
vehicle. Since the registration process requires Intelligent Key signal. — Do not change or modify the Intelli-
erasing all memory in the NATS components Your vehicle can only be driven with the gent Key.
when registering new keys, be sure to take all Intelligent Keys, which are registered to your — Do not use a magnet key holder.
NATS keys that you have to the NISSAN dealer. vehicle’s Intelligent Key system components
and NISSAN Anti-Theft System (NATS*) compo- — Do not place the Intelligent Key near
nents. As many as 4 Intelligent Keys can be equipment that produces a magnetic
CAUTION: field such as a TV, audio equipment
registered and used with one vehicle. The new
Do not allow the NATS key, which contains an keys must be registered by a NISSAN dealer and personal computers.
electrical transponder, to come into contact prior to use with the Intelligent Key system and — Do not allow the Intelligent Key to
with water or salt water. This could affect the NATS of your vehicle. Since the registration come into contact with water or salt
system function. process requires erasing all memory in the water, and do not wash it in a wash-
Intelligent Key system components when re- ing machine. This could affect the
*: Immobilizer gistering new keys, be sure to take all Intelli- system function.
gent Keys that you have to a NISSAN dealer.
INTELLIGENT KEY (if equipped)
D23A131129-EC72DF8E-3839-4A10-B653-5A3C21AA4EAA
. If an Intelligent Key is lost or stolen,
*: Immobilizer NISSAN recommends erasing the ID code
of that Intelligent Key. This will prevent
CAUTION: the Intelligent Key from unauthorized use
to unlock the vehicle. For information
. Be sure to carry the Intelligent Key with regarding the erasing procedure, please
you. Do not leave the vehicle with the contact a NISSAN dealer.
Intelligent Key inside.
. Be sure to carry the Intelligent Key with Mechanical key
D23A131129-27686E3E-B0BA-4AE2-BC3C-098622CFBBB4
you when driving. The Intelligent Key is a
precision device with a built-in transmit-
ter. To avoid damaging it, please note the
following.
SPA2502
— The Intelligent Key is water resistant;
1. Intelligent Key (2) however, wetting may damage the
2. Mechanical key (inside Intelligent Key) (2) Intelligent Key. If the Intelligent Key
gets wet, immediately wipe until it is
3. Key number plate (1) completely dry.
— Do not bend, drop or strike it against
WARNING:
another object.
. The Intelligent Key transmits radio waves — If the outside temperature is below SPA2033
that can adversely affect medical electric -10°C (14°F), the battery of the Intelli-
equipment. gent Key may not function properly. To remove the mechanical key, release the lock
knob at the back of the Intelligent Key.
. If you have a pacemaker, you should — Do not place the Intelligent Key for an
contact the medical equipment manufac- extended period in a place where To install the mechanical key, firmly insert it
turer to ask if it will be affected by the temperatures exceed 60°C (140°F). into the Intelligent Key until the lock knob
returns to the lock position.
DOORS
D23A131129-31D89129-E8CB-49D1-AFC6-56EC9681D9FC
Use the mechanical key to lock or unlock the LOCKINGD23A131129-400056F2-0846-4545-85D1-1C86A35F664C
WITH INSIDE LOCK KNOB
doors and tailgate (if equipped). (See “Doors” WARNING:
(P.3-4) and “Tailgate” (P.3-19).) . Always look before opening any doors, to
avoid an accident with oncoming traffic.
. To help avoid risk of injury or death
through unintended operation of the
vehicle and or its systems, including
entrapment in windows or inadvertent
door lock activation, do not leave chil-
dren, people who require the assistance
of others or pets unattended in your
vehicle. Additionally, the temperature in-
side a closed vehicle on a warm day can SPA2817
quickly become high enough to cause a
significant risk of injury or death to
people and pets. CAUTION:
When locking the doors using the inside lock
LOCKINGD23A131129-8B237026-903C-4D03-957E-B72E3EA5A527
WITH KEY knob, be sure not to leave the key or
Intelligent Key in the vehicle.
To lock the front doors, push the inside lock
knob to the lock position , and then close the
door while pulling the outside door handle.
To lock the rear doors (if equipped), push the
inside lock knob to the lock position and
then close the door.
To unlock, pull the inside lock knob to the
unlock position .
For driver’s door (with power door lock
SPA2588
switch):
To lock the door, insert the mechanical key to When the doors are locked, you do not need to
the door key cylinder and turn the key to the operate the inside lock knob. Just pull the
front side of the vehicle . inside door handle to open the driver’s door.
To unlock the door, turn the key to the rear of
the vehicle .
LOCKING WITH POWER DOOR LOCK REAR ACCESS DOORS (King Cab mod-
SWITCH (if equipped)
D23A131129-C1BC5CD1-4D66-45B1-AC0C-C52510A64912
els) GUID-027C3AD1-6893-49AD-A001-C480D6CF93C4
JVP0323X
CAUTION:
. When locking the doors using the power
door lock switch, be sure not to leave the
key in the vehicle.
JVP0321X JVP0279X
. When the Intelligent Key (if equipped) is
left in the vehicle, and you try to lock the 2. From the inside, pull the door handle The child safety rear door locks help prevent
door using the power door lock switch toward the front of the vehicle. rear doors from being opened accidentally,
after getting out of the vehicle, all the especially when small children are in the
doors will unlock automatically after the vehicle.
door is closed.
When the levers are in the lock position , the
To unlock, push the power door lock switch to child safety rear door locks engage and the
the unlock position . rear doors can only be opened by the outside
door handles.
To disengage, move the levers to the unlock
position .
INTELLIGENT KEY OPERATING RANGE . When the ignition switch is in the “ACC” or
D23A131129-729560DD-8205-4DC4-9F2F-DAD351CC5E3A “ON” position
The Intelligent Key system (opening/closing
doors with the door handle request switch)
can be set to remain inactive. (See “Settings”
(P.2-27).)
JVP0312X
The Intelligent Key functions can only be used USING INTELLIGENT KEY SYSTEM
D23A131129-F0B1F0DE-CCA9-43E9-A09A-237106A1A966
when the Intelligent Key is within the specified
operating range from the request switch .
SPA2407
When the Intelligent Key battery is discharged
or strong radio waves are present near the . Do not push the door handle request
operating location, the Intelligent Key system’s switch with the Intelligent Key held in your
operating range becomes narrower, and the hand as illustrated. The close distance to
Intelligent Key may not function properly. the door handle will cause the Intelligent
The operating range is within 80 cm (31.50 in) Key system to have difficulty recognizing
from each request switch . that the Intelligent Key is outside the
If the Intelligent Key is too close to the door vehicle.
glass or door handle, the request switches may . After locking the doors using the door
not function. SPA2075 handle request switch, make sure that the
doors have been securely locked by oper-
When the Intelligent Key is within the operating The request switch will not function under the ating the door handles.
range, it is possible for anyone, even someone following conditions:
who does not carry the Intelligent Key, to push . When locking the doors using the door
the request switch to lock/unlock the doors. . When another Intelligent Key is left inside handle request switch, make sure to have
the vehicle the Intelligent Key in your possession
. When the Intelligent Key is not within the before operating the door handle request
operational range switch to prevent the Intelligent Key from
being left in the vehicle.
. When any door is open or not closed
securely . The door handle request switch is opera-
tional only when the Intelligent Key has
. When the Intelligent Key battery is dis-
been detected by the Intelligent Key sys-
charged
tem.
. Do not pull the door handle before pushing Lockout protection: Automatic relock:
D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8 D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
the door handle request switch. The door To prevent the Intelligent Key from being All doors will be locked automatically unless
will be unlocked but will not open. Release accidentally locked in the vehicle, lockout one of the following operations is performed
the door handle once and pull it again to protection is equipped with the Intelligent Key within 30 seconds after pushing the request
open the door. system. switch while the doors are locked.
. When the Intelligent Key is left in the vehicle . Opening any doors.
and you try to lock the door using the . Pushing the ignition switch.
power door lock switch after getting out of If during the preset time period the “UNLOCK”
the vehicle, all the doors will unlock auto- button on the Intelligent Key is pushed, all
matically and a chime will sound after the doors will be locked automatically after the
door is closed. next preset time.
CAUTION: BATTERYD23A131129-694B9242-4F14-4C6C-A7EF-1DBC79A799B6
SAVER SYSTEM
The lockout protection may not function When all the following conditions are met for a
under the following conditions: period of time, the battery saver system will cut
SPA2333
off the power supply to prevent battery dis-
. When the Intelligent Key is placed on top charge.
When you carry the Intelligent Key with you, of the instrument panel.
. The ignition switch is in the “ACC” position,
you can lock or unlock all doors by pushing the . When the Intelligent Key is placed inside and
door handle request switch (driver’s or front of the glove box. . All doors are closed, and
passenger’s door) within the range of opera- . When the Intelligent Key is placed inside . The shift lever is in the “P” (Park) position
tion. of the door pockets. (automatic transmission model).
When you lock or unlock the doors, the hazard . When the Intelligent Key is placed inside
indicator will flash as a confirmation. For de- or near metallic materials. WARNINGD23A131129-52B7210C-448C-4D23-B94E-29C54E13C25E
AND AUDIBLE REMINDERS
tails, see “Hazard indicator and horn operation” The Intelligent Key system is equipped with a
(P.3-13). The lockout protection may function when
the Intelligent Key is outside the vehicle but function that is designed to minimize improper
is too close to the vehicle. operations of the Intelligent Key and to help
Locking doors
D23A131129-B4FCD40E-8D09-4976-994F-25AB13213F3F prevent the vehicle from being stolen. A chime
1. Push the ignition switch to the “OFF” or beep sounds inside and outside the vehicle
position. UnlockingD23A131129-1DD71CE6-1253-433C-BB5E-B249A1017F04
doors and a warning message appears in the vehicle
2. Carry the Intelligent Key with you. 1. Carry the Intelligent Key with you. information display.
3. Close all doors. 2. Push the door handle request switch . See the troubleshooting guide on the next
3. All doors will be unlocked. page and “Vehicle information display (models
4. Push the door handle request switch
with color display)” (P.2-20).
(driver’s or front passenger’s door). If a door handle is pulled while unlocking the
5. All doors will be locked. doors, that door may not be unlocked. Return-
ing the door handle to its original position will
6. Operate door handles to confirm that the unlock the door. If the door does not unlock,
doors have been securely locked. after returning the door handle, push the door
handle request switch to unlock the door.
Pre-driving checks and adjustments 3-9
CAUTION:
When the chime or beep sounds or the
warning message appears, be sure to check
both the vehicle and the Intelligent Key.
TROUBLESHOOTING GUIDE
D23A131129-8566B9C0-7A4A-4F93-A35E-3FE8C23026E2
CAUTION:
SPA2349
. After locking the doors using the Intelli-
LOCK button gent Key, be sure that the doors have
UNLOCK button been securely locked by operating the
door handles.
Operating range
D23A131129-5959E3AE-2DFF-4E2E-BDE3-D207B89B5409 . When locking the doors using the Intelli-
The remote keyless entry system allows you to gent Key, be sure not to leave the key in
lock/unlock all doors. The operating distance the vehicle.
depends upon the conditions around the
vehicle. To securely operate the lock and Unlocking doors
D23A131129-E8368828-6C46-45BC-A5E3-1FCB244F2D0C
unlock buttons, approach the vehicle to about
1 m (3.3 ft) from the door. 1. Push the “UNLOCK” button on the
Intelligent Key.
The remote keyless entry system will not
function under the following conditions: 2. All doors will be unlocked.
. When the Intelligent Key is not within the Automatic relock:
D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
operational range. All doors will be locked automatically unless
. When the Intelligent Key battery is dis- one of the following operations is performed
charged. within 30 seconds after pushing the “UNLOCK”
For information regarding the replacement of a button on the Intelligent Key while the
battery, see “Battery” (P.8-21). doors are locked.
. Opening any doors.
. Pushing the ignition switch.
If during the preset time period the “UNLOCK”
button on the Intelligent Key is pushed,
all doors will be locked automatically after the
next preset time.
HOOD
D23A131129-8D1A6611-B742-4C67-9DEA-06DF085C8601
4. Repeat steps 2 and 3 again. The security indicator light indicates that the
security systems on the vehicle are operational. WARNING:
5. Start the engine.
6. Repeat the steps above until all possible If NATS is malfunctioning, this light will remain . The hood must be closed and latched
interferences are eliminated. on while the ignition switch is in the “ON” securely before driving. Failure to do so
position. could cause the hood to fly open and
If this procedure allows the engine to start, result in an accident.
NISSAN recommends placing the registered If the light remains on and/or the engine
NATS key separate from other devices to avoid does not start, contact a NISSAN dealer for . Never open the hood if steam or smoke is
interference. NATS service as soon as possible. Be sure to coming from the engine compartment to
bring all Intelligent Keys that you have when avoid injury.
FCC Notice: visiting a NISSAN dealer for service.
This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC
Rules. Operation is subject to the following
two conditions: (1) this device may not cause
harmful interference, and (2) this device must
accept any interference received, including
interference that may cause undesired op-
eration.
Note: Changes or modifications not expressly
approved by the party responsible for com-
pliance could void the user’s authority to
operate the equipment.
SIC2045
JVP0371X
Type B GUID-AEA692BB-4B07-454D-8D77-B75D8B432045
JVP0365X
FUEL-FILLER CAP
D23A131129-25C2660B-98FD-4841-8669-3BC0017902DC
Type A GUID-845963BB-55F6-44B0-980C-7FAF6DB1A0DE
JVP0211X JVP0370X
The fuel-filler cap is a ratcheting type. Turn the To open the fuel-filler cap, turn the key
cap counterclockwise to remove. Tighten the counterclockwise .
cap clockwise until ratchet clicks, more than Turn the fuel-filler cap counterclockwise
3-18 Pre-driving checks and adjustments
TAILGATE GUID-29E25652-C5B6-4E82-BB53-B4BFB8F68D1B
SPA1872
injury.
WARNING:
. Do not place cargo higher than the seat-
. Do not drive the vehicle with the tailgate backs. In a sudden stop or collision,
down. unsecured cargo could cause personal
. While driving, never allow anyone to ride injury.
in the cargo area. Abrupt braking or . Overloading not only can shorten the life
stopping could lead to personal injury. of your vehicle and the tire, but can also
cause unsafe vehicle handling and longer
Closing the tailgate
GUID-E9351376-10E6-4437-AF91-713151402671
braking distances. This may cause a
When closing the tailgate, make sure that the premature tire failure which could result
latches or levers are securely locked. in a serious accident and personal injury.
JVP0619X
Failures caused by overloading are not
Type B covered by the vehicle’s warranty.
TIE DOWN HOOKS (if equipped)
GUID-E720082F-65C9-4D22-8507-C057BD8EC1DE For your convenience, four tie down hooks are
placed on the inside of the truck box. These . Do not install accessories over the gap
may be used to help secure cargo loaded into between the front and rear side channels.
the truck box. Doing so could affect the rear structure in
certain rear impacts, which could result in
. The weight of the cargo load must be serious injury.
evenly distributed over both the front and
rear axles. The C-Channel system allows you to move tie-
. All cargo should be securely fastened with down clamps in the bed to the best location to
ropes or straps to prevent it from shifting secure a load.
or sliding within the vehicle. The tie-down cleats must be installed so the
clamp is properly seated in the notches in the
C-CHANNEL GUID-B4F9BFB5-35A2-40A9-A77A-5854819ED0FE
SYSTEM (if equipped) rail. If the tie-down cleat is not seated in the
JVP0314X
notches, it will not be properly tightened. The
Type A WARNING: bolt in the center of the cleat must be securely
tightened.
. Properly install and tighten the tie-down
cleats into the C-Channel system. Also, do Check the tightness of the tie-down cleat
not attach any rope or straps directly to periodically during a trip to make sure the
the channel. Failure to properly install the center bolt has not become loose.
tie-down cleats or attaching ropes or
straps directly to the channel can cause
the cargo to become unsecured. In a
sudden stop or collision, unsecured cargo
could cause personal injury.
. Properly secure all cargo with ropes or
straps to help prevent it from sliding or
shifting. In a sudden stop or collision,
unsecured cargo could cause personal
JVP0357X
Side channels
Install the tie-down cleat as follows:
1. Loosen the center bolt completely.
JVP0359X JVP0360X
JVP0406X
CAUTION:
Do not put a load on the sport bar as the
examples shown in the illustration. The sport
bar is an accessory for ornamental purposes
which is not designed to support and hold
the weight of the objects including tension
and pressure on itself.
JVP0362X JVP0361X
STEERING WHEEL ADJUSTMENT (if the headlights of the vehicle behind you
WARNING: obstructs your vision at night.
equipped) GUID-17E1EB4D-33E7-4641-8593-841D1033EB28
Adjust the position of all mirrors before Push the adjusting lever during the day for
WARNING: driving. Do not adjust the mirror positions the best rearward visibility.
while driving so that full attention may be
Never adjust the steering wheel while driving given to vehicle operation. Automatic anti-glare type
D23A131129-6F103A5E-198A-40B3-BAD0-E4628D528631
so that full attention may be given to vehicle
operation. INSIDE REARVIEW MIRROR
D23A131129-3D311780-23D0-4B3C-AF4C-8B38BCD0F0BB
While holding the inside rearview mirror, adjust
the mirror angles until the desired position is
achieved.
SPA2162
Type A
SPA2225
JVP0132X
Type B
The inside rearview mirror is designed so that it
automatically changes reflection according to
the intensity of the headlights of the vehicle
following you.
The anti-glare system will be automatically
SPA2143 turned on when you push the ignition switch
to the “ON” position.
Pull the adjusting lever when the glare from
When the system is turned on, the indicator Adjusting Defogging (ifGUID-8DA51831-C7BB-463B-A832-E0FD93E2F338
equipped)
D23A131129-6CD14C69-6323-4940-BD8D-C96CE05BE1D2
light will illuminate and excessive glare from
Manual type: The outside rearview mirrors will be heated
the headlights of the vehicle behind you will be D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
when the rear window defogger switch is
reduced.
operated.
Push the switch for 3 seconds to make the
inside rearview mirror operate normally and Folding D23A131129-C551A3E7-B939-41F3-A08E-85B4352893EF
the indicator light will turn off. Push the switch
again for 3 seconds to turn the system on. Manual type:
D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
OUTSIDED23A131129-A58F5C79-53BB-4B4C-99AE-FA7AA426C90E
REARVIEW MIRRORS Remote control type:
D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
SPA1829
PARKING BRAKE
D23A131129-13486B6E-8238-4DF0-9F9B-1B1BA4711EA7
The outside rearview mirrors automatically fold the foot brake pedal. Pull up the parking brake
when the outside rearview mirror folding WARNING: lever slightly, push the button and lower the
switch is pushed in. To unfold, push to the . Never drive the vehicle with the parking lever completely .
switch again. brake applied. The brake will overheat Before driving, be sure that the brake warning
and fail to operate and will lead to an light has turned off.
CAUTION: accident.
Continuously performing the fold/unfold op- . Never release the parking brake from
eration of the outside rearview mirror may outside the vehicle. If the vehicle moves,
cause the switch to stop the operation. it will be impossible to push the brake
pedal and will lead to an accident.
VANITY MIRROR (if equipped)
D23A131129-10CA0FE3-AB2E-485E-8594-B07AED9965F2
. Never use the shift lever in place of the
parking brake. When parking, be sure the
parking brake is fully applied.
. To help avoid risk of injury or death
through unintended operation of the
vehicle and/or its systems, do not leave
children, people who require the assis-
tance of others or pets unattended in
your vehicle. Additionally, the tempera-
ture inside a closed vehicle on a warm
day can quickly become high enough to
cause a significant risk of injury or death
to people and pets.
SIC3869
SPA2110
MEMO
Antenna .............................................................................................................
.... 4-76 Bluetooth® Hands-Free Phone System (Type C) ............. .... 4-87
Roof antenna .........................................................................................
.... 4-76 Regulatory information ..............................................................
.... 4-88
Pillar antenna ........................................................................................
.... 4-76 Control buttons and microphone .....................................
.... 4-88
Car phone and CB radio ......................................................................
.... 4-77 Pairing procedure ...........................................................................
.... 4-88
Bluetooth® Hands-Free Phone System (Type A) .............. .... 4-77 Phonebook ...........................................................................................
.... 4-88
Regulatory information .................................................................
.... 4-78 Making a call .......................................................................................
.... 4-88
Control buttons and microphone ........................................ .... 4-78 Receiving a call .................................................................................
.... 4-89
Bluetooth® settings ..........................................................................
.... 4-78 During a call ........................................................................................
.... 4-89
Using the system ...............................................................................
.... 4-80 Ending a call ........................................................................................
.... 4-89
General settings ..................................................................................
.... 4-82 Bluetooth® settings .......................................................................
.... 4-89
Bluetooth® Hands-Free Phone System (Type B) .............. .... 4-83 Telephone setup ..............................................................................
.... 4-89
Regulatory information .................................................................
.... 4-84
Using the system ...............................................................................
.... 4-84
Bluetooth® settings ..........................................................................
.... 4-86
NISSANCONNECT OWNER’S
SAFETY PRECAUTIONS
MANUAL (if equipped)
D23A131129-B34AAD47-D464-4320-8D14-7C930DB50A7C
GUID-864BAE36-947E-4258-B0CA-DD33F085EFD1
For models with NissanConnect System, refer
to the NissanConnect Owner’s Manual that
WARNING:
includes the following information. . Do not adjust the heater and air condi-
Available functions may vary depending on the tioner controls or audio controls while
models and specifications. driving so that full attention may be given
to vehicle operation.
. Audio
. Hands-free phone . If you noticed any foreign objects enter-
ing the system hardware, spilled liquid on
. Apple CarPlay the system, or noticed smoke or fumes
. Android Auto coming out from the system, or any other
. Navigation unusual operation is observed, stop using
. Voice recognition the system immediately and contact the
. Information and settings viewable on Nis- nearest NISSAN dealer. Ignoring such
sanConnect conditions may lead to an accident, fire
or electric shock.
. Do not disassemble or modify this sys-
tem. If you do, it may lead to an accident,
fire, or electric shock.
CAUTION:
Do not use the system when the engine is not
running for extended periods of time to
prevent battery discharge.
CENTER MULTI-FUNCTION
CONTROL PANEL (for type F audio)
GUID-AC162527-D7C2-4915-A781-A21E8A1D36DB
HOW TO USE TOUCH SCREEN DISPLAY
GUID-D9DE06C8-EA9F-4919-877D-920228A7CF63
WARNING:
. The glass display screen may break if it is
hit with a hard or sharp object. If the
glass screen breaks, do not touch it.
Doing so could result in an injury.
. To clean the display, never use a rough
cloth, alcohol, benzine, thinner or any
kind of solvent or paper towel with a
chemical cleaning agent. They will
scratch or deteriorate the panel.
. Do not splash any liquid such as water or
car fragrance on the display. Contact with
liquid will cause the system to malfunc-
tion.
To help ensure safe driving, some functions
cannot be operated while driving.
The on-screen functions that are not available
while driving will be “grayed out” or muted.
Park the vehicle in a safe location and then
operate the navigation system.
CAUTION:
JVH1073X
. ALWAYS give your full attention to driving.
1. Phone button (P.4-87) 9. Brightness control/display on·off button . Avoid using vehicle features that could
2. Power/VOL (volume) dial (P. 4-69) (P. 4-5) distract you. If distracted, you could lose
3. Display screen (P.4-4) 10. SETUP button (P.4-6) control of your vehicle and cause an
11. INFO button (P.4-5) accident.
4. BACK button (P.4-5)
5. ENTER/Scroll dial (P.4-5)
6. Audio control buttons (P.4-69)
7. CAMERA button (P.4-7, P.4-13)
8. For navigation system control buttons
refer to the separate Navigation System
Owner’s Manual.
When “Manual” is selected, you can set the Select this key to return all settings to default.
clock mode manually from the “Set Clock Software Licenses (if equipped):
D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
Manually” screen. Select this key to view software license infor-
Select “Auto” to automatically maintain the mation.
time using GPS.
JVH1794X
. Set Clock Manually: Traffic Messages settings
GUID-FA26F520-3A2B-4A5E-A226-F7181F967B3D Type A
Mode (AM/PM) (if equipped), Hours, Minutes, Traffic information guidance, announcement
Day, Month and Year can be set manually if and warning settings can be adjusted.
“Manual” is selected in the Clock Mode Traffic Announcement (TA) information can be
setting. received only in the area where the service is
. Daylight Savings Time: available.
Turns the daylight savings time on or off.
. Time Zone: Radio settings
GUID-6B4F6996-CC39-4653-84DA-06C730197538
Select the applicable time zone from the Traffic Announcement (TA) related settings can
list. be turned on or off. When this item is turned on,
the received traffic announcement information
Language: D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8 will be tuned to automatically when received.
Select a language to be displayed on the Traffic Announcement (TA) information can be JVH1790X
screen. received only in the area where the service is Type B
Camera Settings: available.
D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
See “How to adjust the screen” (P.4-11) or “How
to adjust the screen” (P.4-19) for details.
Temperature Unit:
D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
Select the temperature unit from °C and °F.
Touch Click:D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
Turns the touchscreen click feature on or off.
When turned on, a click sound will be heard
every time a key on the screen is touched.
When backing up the vehicle up a hill, the When backing up the vehicle down a hill, the
distance guide lines and the vehicle width distance guide lines and the vehicle width
guide lines are shown closer than the actual guide lines are shown further than the actual
distance. For example, the display shows 1 m (3 distance. For example, the display shows 1 m (3
ft) to the place , but the actual 1 m (3 ft) ft) to the place , but the actual 1 m (3 ft)
distance on the hill is the place . Note that any distance on the hill is the place . Note that any
object on the hill is viewed in the monitor object on the hill is viewed in the monitor closer
further than it appears. than it appears.
Backing D23A131129-C325ADAF-DDE4-4FEE-9CBA-1FF7880E0E17
up near a projecting object Backing up behind a projecting object
D23A131129-4445394E-6B6A-4CB6-8B9E-6E1E5421D96B
HOW TO PARK WITH PREDICTIVE
COURSE LINES (if equipped)
GUID-37C63B59-5411-45F7-B4C8-36DA32EC850D
WARNING:
. If the tires are replaced with different
sized tires, the predictive course lines
may not be displayed correctly.
. On a snow-covered or slippery road,
there may be a difference between the
predictive course lines and the actual
course line.
. If the battery is disconnected or becomes
discharged, the predictive course lines
may not be displayed correctly. If this
occurs, perform the following proce-
dures.
— Turn the steering wheel from lock to
lock while the engine is running.
— Drive the vehicle on a straight road for
more than 5 minutes.
WAE0134X JVH0895X
The predictive course lines (if equipped) do The position is shown further than the
not touch the object in the display. However, position in the display. However, the position
the vehicle may hit the object if it projects over is actually at the same distance as the
the actual backing up course. position . The vehicle may hit the object
when backing up to the position if the object
projects over the actual backing up course.
NOTE:
Do not adjust the screen while the vehicle is
moving.
Adjusting screen (Type A)
GUID-8367AAE9-8A6B-4275-ADC2-522A9BD95BE1
1. Push the SETUP button.
2. Select the “System” key.
3. Select the “Camera Settings” key.
4. Select the item you wish to adjust.
. Display Mode:
Adjusts to fit the level of lighting in the
vehicle. Touch the “Display Mode” key to
cycle through options of the mode (Day,
Night and Auto).
. Brightness:
Adjusts the brightness of the display.
. Contrast:
Adjusts the level of contrast.
. Color:
Adjusts the level of the color.
SAA1897 SAA1898
Adjusting screen (Type B)
GUID-4800F9C5-8EDB-47C0-8998-93B814F44C6B
1. Visually check that the parking space is 3. Slowly back up the vehicle adjusting the
safe before parking your vehicle. steering wheel so that the predictive
2. The rear view of the vehicle is displayed on course lines enter the parking space .
the screen as illustrated when the shift 4. Maneuver the steering wheel to make the
lever is moved to the “R” (Reverse) position. vehicle width guide lines parallel to the
parking space while referring to the
predictive course lines .
5. When the vehicle is parked in the space
completely, move the shift lever to the “P”
(Park) position (AT model) or the “N” (Neu-
tral) position (MT model) and apply the
parking brake. JVH0653X
1. Push the ENTER/SETTING button . HOW TO TURN ON AND OFF PREDICTIVE . Vertical lines may be seen in objects on the
2. Turn the TUNE·FOLDER dial to highlight COURSE LINES (if equipped) screen. This is due to strong reflected light
the “Brightness” or the “Contrast” key.
GUID-BEECEC97-D559-4351-A26C-AA2930877B10 from the bumper. This is not a malfunction.
1. Push the CAMERA button.
. The screen may flicker under fluorescent
3. Push the ENTER/SETTING button . 2. Touch the “Predictive Course Lines” key to light. This is not a malfunction.
4. Adjust the level using the TUNE·FOLDER dial turn on and off the predictive course lines. . The colors of objects on the rear view
and then push the ENTER/SETTING The “Predictive Course Lines” key can also be monitor may differ somewhat from those
button to apply the adjustment. shown by pushing the MENU button, touching of the actual object.
the “Settings” key and then touching the . Objects on the monitor may not be clear in
Adjusting screen (Type C)
GUID-AF9144A1-84BE-476B-9F22-50C390502914 “Camera” key. a dark place or at night. This is not a
malfunction.
HOW TO TURN ON AND OFF GUIDE . If dirt, rain or snow attaches to the camera,
LINES (if equipped)
GUID-240D2D2B-904E-4D2E-83DB-C3B6E59F2BE0 the rear view monitor may not clearly
When the rear view monitor is displayed, you display objects. Clean the camera.
can switch the vehicle width guide lines and . Do not use alcohol, benzine or thinner to
distance guide lines on/off by pushing the clean the camera. This will cause discolora-
CAMERA button. tion. To clean the camera, wipe with a cloth
dampened with diluted mild cleaning agent
OPERATING TIPS
D23A131129-96C76C8D-C6E0-46C3-98CB-171E224A38D4 and then wipe with a dry cloth.
. When the shift lever is shifted to the “R” . Do not damage the camera as the monitor
(Reverse) position, the monitor screen screen may be adversely affected.
WAE0138X automatically changes to the rear view . Do not use wax on the camera window.
monitor mode. However, the radio can be Wipe off any wax with a clean cloth
1. Push the CAMERA button .
heard. dampened with mild detergent diluted with
2. Touch the “Display Settings” key. . It may take some time until the rear view water.
3. Select the setting items you wish to adjust monitor or the normal screen is displayed
by touching or by turning and pushing the after the shift lever has been shifted to “R”
TUNE·SCROLL dial . (Reverse) from another position or to
Available setting items: another position from “R” (Reverse). Objects
may be distorted momentarily until the rear
. Brightness view monitor screen is displayed comple-
. Contrast tely.
. Tint . When the temperature is extremely high or
. Colour/Color low, the screen may not clearly display
. Black Level objects. This is not a malfunction.
The “Display Settings” key can also be shown by . When strong light directly enters the cam-
pushing the MENU button , touching the era, objects may not be displayed clearly.
“Settings” key and then touching the “Camera” This is not a malfunction.
key.
WARNING:
For Australia and New Zealand:
JVH1773X WAE0085X
Type C . The front camera view may be obscured
Type A
when fitting equipment to the front of
the vehicle such as bullbar, nudge bar or
additional lamps.
. The driver is always responsible for
safety during parking and other man-
oeuvres.
JVH0648X JVH1783X
Type B Type D
With the ignition switch in the “ON” position,
push the CAMERA button (if equipped)/DISP
button (if equipped) or move the shift lever to
the “R” (Reverse) position to operate the Around
View Monitor. The monitor displays various
views of the position of the vehicle.
Available views:
. Bird’s-eye View
The surrounding view of the vehicle.
. Front-side View
The view around and ahead of the front
passenger’s side wheel.
Front and rear view . Green line : approx. 3 m (10 ft) 90 degrees or more, a predictive course line
D23A131129-6737016E-C9E9-45CE-8922-6A19C860AF64
Vehicle width guide lines : is displayed only on the opposite side of the
turn.
Indicate the approximate vehicle width.
Predictive course lines : Bird’s-eye view (Type A)
GUID-8A4F9444-D54C-4D1E-AA00-1C6190888F34
JVH0894X JVH1779X
When backing up the vehicle down a hill, the The predictive course lines do not touch the
JVH0893X distance guide lines and the vehicle width object on the display. However, the vehicle may
guide lines are shown further than the actual hit the object if it projects over the actual
When backing up the vehicle up a hill, the distance. For example, the display shows 1 m (3 moving course.
distance guide lines and the vehicle width ft) to the place , but the actual 1 m (3 ft)
guide lines are shown closer than the actual distance on the hill is the place . Note that
distance. For example, the display shows 1 m (3 any object on the hill is viewed in the monitor
ft) to the place , but the actual 1 m (3 ft) closer than it appears.
distance on the hill is the place . Note that
any object on the hill is viewed in the monitor
further than it appears.
Backing up behind a projecting object HOW TO SWITCH THE DISPLAY . A different screen is selected (when the
D23A131129-FCC1B5E4-CC56-430E-9B1C-F00F114D520B GUID-F0747FC7-E321-4A9B-AA55-7FEEB1CC7330
shift lever is not in the “R” (Reverse) posi-
tion).
. This function is designed as an aid to the 1. To adjust the screen brightness when the 1. Push the ENTER/SETTING button .
driver in detecting large stationary ob- Around View Monitor is displayed, push the 2. Turn the TUNE·FOLDER dial to highlight
jects to help avoid damaging the vehicle. brightness control/display on·off “ ” but- the “Brightness” or the “Contrast” key.
The system will not detect small objects ton .
below the bumper, and may not detect 3. Push the ENTER/SETTING button .
2. Adjust brightness to the preferred setting
objects that are too close to the bumper using the ENTER/Scroll dial . 4. Adjust the level using the TUNE·FOLDER dial
or on the ground. and then push the ENTER/SETTING
. If your vehicle sustains damage to the Operation with touch screen:
D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8 button to apply the adjustment.
bumper fascia, leaving it misaligned or 1. Push the SETUP button.
bent, the sensing zone may be altered
Adjusting screen (Type C)
GUID-7CB6F4A9-364E-49A0-9136-BB643653F192
2. Select the “System” key.
causing inaccurate measurement of ob-
stacles or false alarms. 3. Select the “Camera Settings” key.
4. Select the item you wish to adjust.
CAUTION: . Display Mode:
Adjusts to fit the level of lighting in the
Keep the interior of the vehicle as quiet as vehicle. Touch the “Display Mode” key to
possible to hear the tone clearly. cycle through options of the mode (Day,
Night and Auto).
HOW TO ADJUST THE SCREEN (if . Brightness:
equipped)D23A131129-FEC9E114-AFCB-4786-B193-2F7948EC2395 Adjusts the brightness of the display.
NOTE: . Contrast: WAE0086X
Adjusts the level of contrast.
Do not adjust the screen while the vehicle is
. Color: 1. Push the MENU button .
moving.
Adjusts the level of the color. 2. Touch the “Settings” key.
Adjusting screen (Type A)
GUID-0E99F2E4-F0C5-4008-9AC5-77B3AFA5ED8B 3. Touch the “Camera” key.
Operation with buttons: Adjusting screen (Type B)
GUID-920B4077-1EA0-461F-AB0A-77DBC10F58E6
D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8 4. Touch the “Display Settings” key.
5. Select the setting items you wish to adjust
by touching or by turning and pushing the
TUNE·SCROLL dial .
Available setting items:
. Brightness
. Contrast
. Tint
. Colour/Color
. Black Level
JVH1782X JVH0653X
VENTILATORS
D23A131129-8F206902-B1E0-4EE3-A75B-965E3A845AF0
OPERATING TIPS . There may be differences in clearness CENTER VENTILATORS
D23A131129-FC75F997-C15E-46F8-A7D6-37631CD8477F
between each camera view of the bird’s- D23A131129-F72A1997-8A5D-4519-BE35-AD1AEE64A361
JVH1520X
SAA2324
1. Air recirculation “ ” button Temperature control:
D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
2. Rear defogger “ ” button (See “Defog- Turn the temperature control dial to set the
ger switch” (P.2-38).) (if equipped) desired temperature.
3. Temperature control dial
Air flow control:
D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
4. “A/C” (air conditioner) button
This dial allows you to select the air flow
5. Fan speed control “ ” dial outlets.
6. Air flow control dial
— Air flows from center and side venti-
Controls lators.
GUID-1A73B8CC-8C87-40B5-8597-3E2CEFD79895
— Air flows from center and side venti-
Turning system on/off:
D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8 lators and foot outlets.
To turn on the system, turn the fan speed
JVH0612X — Air flows mainly from the foot outlets.
control “ ” dial out of the “0” position. Turn
Right-Hand Drive (RHD) model (example) — Air flows from the defogger and foot
the dial counter clockwise to the “0” position to
When the engine coolant temperature and outlets.
turn off the system.
outside air temperature are low, the air flow
from the foot outlets may not operate. How- — Air flows mainly from the defogger
Fan speed control:
ever, this is not a malfunction. After the coolant
D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8 outlets.
Turn the fan speed control “ ” dial clockwise
temperature warms up, the air flow from the to increase the fan speed. Outside air D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
circulation:
foot outlets will operate normally.
Turn the fan speed control “ ” dial counter- Push the air recirculation “ ” button. (The
The sensors and , located on the instru- clockwise to decrease the fan speed. indicator light will turn off.) The air flow is
ment panel, help maintain a constant tempera- drawn from outside the vehicle.
ture. Do not put anything on or around the
sensors. Select the outside air circulation mode for
normal air conditioning operation.
Air recirculation:
D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
Dehumidified defogging:
D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
Push the air recirculation “ ” button. (The This mode is used to defog the windows and
indicator light will illuminate.) dehumidify the air.
The air flow is recirculated inside the vehicle. 1. Push the air recirculation “ ” button. (The
indicator light will turn off.)
A/C (Air Conditioner) operation:
D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
2. Turn the air flow control dial to the “ ”
Push the “A/C” button to turn on or off the air
position.
conditioner. When the air conditioner is on, the
“A/C” indicator light on the button illuminates. 3. Turn the fan speed control “ ” dial to the
desired position.
Air conditioner operation
GUID-D1E71FE5-2719-426B-9266-C44163DE486B 4. Push the “A/C” button. (The “A/C” indicator
Cooling: light will illuminate.)
D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
The cooler should be operated for approxi- 5. Turn the temperature control dial to the
mately 10 minutes at least once a month. This desired position.
helps prevent damage to the cooling function
due to the lack of lubrication.
1. Push the air recirculation “ ” button. (The
indicator light will turn off.)
2. Turn the air flow control dial to the “ ”
position.
3. Turn the fan speed control “ ” dial to the
desired position.
4. Push the “A/C” button. (The “A/C” indicator
light will illuminate.)
5. Turn the temperature control dial to the
desired position.
A visible mist may be seen coming from the
ventilators in hot, humid conditions as the air is
cooled rapidly. This does not indicate a mal-
function.
For quick cooling when the outside tempera-
ture is high, push the air recirculation “ ”
button. (The indicator light will turn on.) Be sure
to return the air recirculation “ ” button to
turn off for normal cooling.
2. Turn the air flow control dial to the “ ” 3. Turn the fan speed control “ ” dial to the A visible mist may be seen coming from the
position. desired position. ventilators in hot, humid conditions as the air is
3. Turn the fan speed control “ ” dial to the 4. Turn the temperature control dial to the cooled rapidly. This does not indicate a mal-
desired position. desired position. function.
4. Turn the temperature control dial to the . For quick cooling when the outside tem-
Heating and defogging:
D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8 perature is high, push the air recirculation
desired position.
This mode heats the interior and defogs the “ ” button. (The indicator light will turn
Defrosting D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
or defogging: windows. on.) Be sure to return the air recirculation
This mode directs the air to the defogger 1. Push the air recirculation “ ” button. (The “ ” button to turn off for normal cooling.
outlets to defrost/defog the windows. indicator light will turn off.) Dehumidified heating:
D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
1. Turn the air flow control dial to the “ ” 2. Turn the air flow control dial to the “ ” This mode is used to heat and dehumidify the
position. position. air.
2. Push the air recirculation “ ” button. (The 3. Turn the fan speed control dial to the 1. Push the air recirculation “ ” button. (The
indicator light will turn off.) desired position. indicator light will turn off.)
3. Turn the fan speed control “ ” dial to the 4. Turn the temperature control dial to the 2. Turn the air flow control dial to the “ ”
desired position. maximum hot (right) position. position.
4. Turn the temperature control dial to the 3. Turn the fan speed control “ ” dial to the
desired position between the middle and
Air conditioner operation
GUID-301B5646-B456-4AFA-85D5-213107796F75
desired position.
the hot (right) position. The air conditioner system should be operated
for approximately 10 minutes at least once a 4. Push the “A/C” button. (The “A/C” indicator
. To remove frost from the windshield light will illuminate.)
month. This helps prevent damage to the air
quickly, turn the temperature control dial
conditioner system due to the lack of lubrica- 5. Turn the temperature control dial to the
to the maximum position and the fan
tion. desired position between the middle and
speed control “ ” dial to the maximum
position. Cooling: the hot (right) position.
D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
. If it is difficult to defog the windshield, turn This mode is used to cool and dehumidify the Dehumidified defogging:
D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
the “A/C” button on. air. This mode is used to defog the windows and
Bi-level heating: 1. Push the air recirculation “ ” button. (The dehumidify the air.
D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
This mode directs cool air from the side and indicator light will turn off.) 1. Push the air recirculation “ ” button. (The
center vents and warm air from the foot 2. Turn the air flow control dial to the “ ” indicator light will turn off.)
outlets. When the temperature control dial is position. 2. Turn the air flow control dial to the “ ”
turned to the maximum hot or cool position, 3. Turn the fan speed control dial to the position.
the air between the ventilators and the foot desired position. 3. Turn the fan speed control “ ” dial to the
outlets is the same temperature.
4. Push the “A/C” button. (The “A/C” indicator desired position.
1. Push the air recirculation “ ” button. (The light will illuminate.) 4. Push the “A/C” button. (The “A/C” indicator
indicator light will turn off.)
5. Turn the temperature control dial to the light will illuminate.)
2. Turn the air flow control dial to the “ ” desired position between the middle and
position. the cool (left) position.
5. Turn the temperature control dial to the MANUAL AIR CONDITIONER AND HEATER (Type B)
desired position. GUID-985BBF35-14B9-4A3D-9EA4-C1E46E5A23E1
JVH0888X
Air flow control: 2. Push the “ ” button. (The indicator light 1. Push the air recirculation “ ” button. (The
D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
Push one of the air flow control buttons to will turn on.) indicator light will turn off.)
select the air flow outlets. 3. Turn the fan speed control “ ” dial to the 2. Push the “ ” button. (The indicator light
desired position. will turn on.)
— Air flows mainly from center and side
ventilators. 4. Turn the temperature control dial to the 3. Turn the fan speed control “ ” dial to the
desired position between the middle and desired position.
— Air flows mainly from center and side
the hot (right) position. 4. Turn the temperature control dial to the
ventilators and foot outlets.
Defrosting D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
or defogging: desired position.
— Air flows mainly from the foot outlet
and partly from the defogger. This mode directs the air to the defogger Heating and defogging:
D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
— Air flows mainly from the defogger outlets to defrost/defog the windows. This mode heats the interior and defogs the
and foot outlets. 1. Turn the fan speed control “ ” dial to the windows.
desired position. 1. Push the air recirculation “ ” button. (The
Outside air D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
circulation:
2. Push the front defogger “ ” button. (The indicator light will turn off.)
Push the air recirculation “ ” button. (The
indicator lights on the front defogger “ ” 2. Push the “ ” button. (The indicator light
indicator light will turn off.) The air flow is
button and the “A/C” button will turn on.) will turn on.)
drawn from outside the vehicle.
Then the air recirculation indicator light will
Select the outside air circulation mode for turn off. 3. Turn the fan speed control “ ” dial to the
normal heating or air conditioning operation. desired position.
3. Turn the temperature control dial to the
Air recirculation: desired position between the middle and 4. Turn the temperature control dial to the
D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
the hot (right) position. maximum hot (right) position.
Push the air recirculation “ ” button on. (The
indicator light will illuminate.) To remove frost from the windshield Air conditioner operation
GUID-2D7DD2B3-4520-4130-97A1-EBAC99FAF3B6
The air will recirculate inside the vehicle. quickly, turn the temperature control dial
The air conditioner system should be operated
to the maximum hot (right) position and
for approximately 10 minutes at least once a
A/C (Air Conditioner) operation: the fan speed control “ ” dial to the
D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8 month. This helps prevent damage to the air
Push the “A/C” button to turn on or off the air maximum position. For the best bi-level
conditioner system due to the lack of lubrica-
conditioner. When the air conditioner is on, the heating performance, do not select the air
tion.
“A/C” indicator light on the button illuminates. recirculation mode. For the best defogging
performance, do not select the air recircu- Cooling: D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
Heater operation
GUID-B8CB7042-6004-4AA0-BA21-1C04D71ADDE1
lation mode. This mode is used to cool and dehumidify the
Heating: D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8 Bi-level heating: air.
D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
This mode is used to direct heated air from the This mode directs cool air from the side/center 1. Push the air recirculation “ ” button. (The
foot outlets. ventilators and warm air from the foot outlets. indicator light will turn off.)
1. Push the air recirculation “ ” button for (When the temperature control dial is turned to 2. Push the “ ” button. (The indicator light
normal heating. (The indicator light will turn the maximum hot (right) or cool (left) position, will turn on.)
off.) the temperatures from the side/center venti-
3. Turn the fan speed control “ ” dial to the
lators and the foot outlets will be the same.)
desired position.
4. Push the “A/C” button. (The indicator light 2. Turn the fan speed control “ ” dial to the
will turn on.) desired position.
5. Turn the temperature control dial to the 3. Turn the temperature control dial to the
desired position between the middle and desired position.
the cool (left) position.
A visible mist may be seen coming from the
ventilators in hot, humid conditions as the air is
cooled rapidly. This does not indicate a mal-
function.
. For quick cooling when the outside tem-
perature is high, push the air recirculation
“ ” button. (The indicator light will turn
on.) Be sure to return the air recirculation
“ ” button to turn off for normal cooling.
Dehumidified heating:
D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
This mode is used to heat and dehumidify the
air.
1. Push the air recirculation “ ” button. (The
indicator light will turn off.)
2. Push the “ ” button. (The indicator light
will turn on.)
3. Turn the fan speed control “ ” dial to the
desired position.
4. Push the “A/C” button. (The indicator light
will turn on.)
5. Turn the temperature control dial to the
desired position between the middle and
the hot (right) position.
Dehumidified defogging:
D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
This mode is used to defog the windows and
dehumidify the air.
1. Push the front defogger “ ” button. (The
indicator lights on the front defogger “ ”
button and the “A/C” button will turn on. )
Then the air recirculation indicator light will
turn off.
SAA0480
. Do not expose the CD to direct sunlight. . Do not leave the USB cable in a place Please note that the use of this accessory with
. CDs that are of poor quality, or are dirty, where it can be pulled unintentionally. iPod, iPhone, or iPad may affect wireless
scratched, covered with fingerprints, or Pulling the cable may damage the port. performance.
that have pin holes may not work properly. The vehicle is not equipped with a USB device. iPad, iPhone, iPod, iPod classic, iPod nano, iPod
. The following CDs may not work properly. USB devices should be purchased separately as shuffle, and iPod touch are trademarks of Apple
— Copy control compact discs (CCCD) necessary. Inc., registered in the U.S. and other countries.
— Recordable compact discs (CD-R) Lightning is a trademark of Apple Inc.
This system cannot be used to format USB
— Rewritable compact discs (CD-RW) devices. To format a USB device, use a personal . Improperly plugging in the iPod may cause
. Do not use the following CDs as they may computer. a checkmark to be displayed on and off
cause the CD player to malfunction. (flickering). Always make sure that the iPod
In some states/area, the USB device for the is connected properly.
— 8 cm (3.1 in) discs front seats plays only sound without images for
regulatory reasons, even when the vehicle is . An iPod nano (1st Generation) may remain
— CDs that are not round
parked. in fast forward or rewind mode if it is
— CDs with a paper label connected during a seek operation. In this
— CDs that are warped, scratched or have This system supports various USB memory case, please manually reset the iPod.
unusual edges. devices, USB hard drives and iPod players. . An iPod nano (2nd Generation) will continue
. This audio system can only play prere- Some USB devices may not be supported by to fast-forward or rewind if it is discon-
corded CDs. It has no capabilities to record this system. nected during a seek operation.
or burn CDs. . Partitioned USB devices may not be played . An incorrect song title may appear when
correctly. the Play Mode is changed while using an
USB (Universal Serial Bus) Connection . Some characters used in other languages iPod nano (2nd Generation).
Port D23A131129-DD3A2103-D64D-477B-9DE0-597F033BD3B3 (Chinese, Japanese, etc.) may not appear . Audiobooks may not play in the same order
properly in the display. Using English lan- as they appear on an iPod.
WARNING: guage characters with a USB device is . Large video files cause slow responses in
recommended. an iPod. The vehicle center display may
Do not connect, disconnect or operate the
USB device while driving. Doing so can be a General notes for USB use: momentarily black out, but will soon re-
distraction. If distracted you could lose con- Refer to your device manufacturer’s owner cover.
trol of your vehicle and cause an accident or information regarding the proper use and care . If an iPod automatically selects large video
serious injury. of the device. files while in the shuffle mode, the vehicle
Notes for iPod use: center display may momentarily black out,
but will soon recover.
CAUTION: “Made for iPod”, “Made for iPhone”, and “Made
for iPad” mean that an electronic accessory has
. Do not force the USB device into the USB been designed to connect specifically to iPod,
connection port. Inserting the USB device iPhone, or iPad, respectively, and has been
tilted or up-side-down into the port may certified by the developer to meet Apple
damage the port. Make sure that the USB performance standards.
device is connected correctly into the USB
connection port. Apple is not responsible for the operation of
this device or its compliance with safety and
regulatory standards.
Bluetooth® audio player (if equipped) Bluetooth® is a trademark and enables music file creation and storage
D23A131129-C82446EA-6506-4881-A55B-5A4E6F78E040
owned by Bluetooth SIG, at the same quality as MP3.
. Some Bluetooth® audio devices may not be Inc., and licensed to Visteon
used with this system. For detailed infor- . Bit rate — Bit rate denotes the number of
Corporation and Robert bits per second used by a digital music files.
mation about Bluetooth® audio devices Bosch GmbH.
that are available for use with this system, The size and quality of a compressed digital
contact a NISSAN dealer. audio file is determined by the bit rate used
Compact Disc (CD)/USB device with when encoding the file.
. Before using a Bluetooth® audio system, MP3/WMA/AAC (if equipped)
the initial registration process for the audio D23A131129-5F81D0A0-D715-4B38-98BD-2ABA8AB39E62 . Sampling frequency — Sampling frequency
device is necessary. Terms: is the rate at which the samples of a signal
D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
. MP3 — MP3 is short for Moving Pictures are converted from analog to digital (A/D
. Operation of the Bluetooth® audio system
Experts Group Audio Layer 3. MP3 is the conversion) per second.
may vary depending on the audio device
that is connected. Confirm the operation most well known compressed digital audio . Multisession — Multisession is one of the
procedure before use. file format. This format allows for near “CD methods for writing data to media. Writing
quality” sound, but at a fraction of the size data once to the media is called a single
. The playback of Bluetooth® audio will be
of normal audio files. MP3 conversion of an session, and writing more than once is
paused under the following conditions. The
audio track from CD can reduce the file size called a multisession.
playback will be resumed after the follow-
ing conditions are completed. by approximately 10:1 ratio (Sampling: 44.1 . ID3/WMA Tag — The ID3/WMA tag is the
kHz, Bit rate: 128 kbps) with virtually no part of the encoded MP3 or WMA file that
— while using a hands-free phone
perceptible loss in quality. MP3 compres- contains information about the digital mu-
— while checking a connection with a cell sion removes the redundant and irrelevant sic file such as song title, artist, album title,
phone parts of a sound signal that the human ear encoding bit rate, track time duration, etc.
. The in-vehicle antenna for Bluetooth® com- doesn’t hear. ID3 tag information is displayed on the
munication is built in the system. Do not . WMA — Windows Media Audio (WMA) is a Album/Artist/Track title line on the display.
place the Bluetooth® audio device in an compressed audio format created by Mi- * Windows® and Windows Media® are registered
area surrounded by metal, far away from crosoft as an alternative to MP3. The WMA trademarks and/or trademarks of Microsoft
the system or in a narrow space where the codec offers greater file compression than Corporation in the United States of America
device closely contacts the body or the the MP3 codec, enabling storage of more and/or other countries.
seat. Otherwise, sound degradation or digital audio tracks in the same amount of
connection interference may occur. space when compared to MP3s at the
. While a Bluetooth® audio device is con- same level of quality.
nected through the Bluetooth® wireless This product is protected by certain intel-
connection, the battery power of the device lectual property rights of Microsoft Cor-
may discharge quicker than usual. poration and third parties. Use or
. This system is compatible with the Blue- distribution of such technology outside of
tooth® AV profile (A2DP and AVRCP). this product is prohibited without a license
from Microsoft or an authorized Microsoft
subsidiary and third parties.
. AAC (if equipped) — Advanced Audio Coding
(AAC) is a compressed audio format. AAC
offers greater file compression than MP3
Playback order:
D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
SAA2494
Specification chart:
D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
For FM-AM radio with compact disc (CD) player type A, B or C
Specification chart:
D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
For FM-AM radio with compact disc (CD) player type D or E
Specification chart:
D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
For FM-AM radio with compact disc (CD) player type F
Troubleshooting guide:
D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
FM-AM RADIO WITH COMPACT DISC (CD) PLAYER (Type A) Audio mainGUID-D3E0E55C-2000-48DE-A229-D32EAA7BFBAF
operation
GUID-F6FC2354-89F5-4A37-B9A6-3E137FDAD6EF
The audio system operates when the ignition
switch is placed in the “ACC” or “ON” position.
2. RADIO button 10. MEDIA button This item is available only when the audio
system is turned on.
3. Day/Night button 11. MUTE button
To configure Audio, Clock, Radio or Language,
4. MIX button 12. Power VOL (volume) dial perform the following procedure.
5. Seek/track (rewind) button 13. RPT (repeat) button
1. Push the button.
6. Seek/track (fast forward) button 14. Station memory buttons
2. Turn the MENU knob clockwise or counter-
7. SETUP button 15. A-Z button clockwise, the display will appear in the
8. Back button 16. ENTER button/MENU knob following order.
Audio � Clock � Radio � Language
Monitor, air conditioner, audio and phone system 4-39
3. Push the ENTER button to select the item. decrease. Push the ENTER button to confirm. minute and push the ENTER button to finish
This mode controls the volume output from the the clock adjustment.
Audio setting:
D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
speakers automatically in relation to vehicle ON/OFF:
Push the button and then select “Audio”.
speed. When “Speed Volume” is displayed, turn Set the clock display between on or off when
Turn the MENU knob, and the mode will change the MENU knob clockwise or counterclockwise the audio unit is turned off. If the clock display
as follows. to adjust the volume level. setting is turned on, the clock will be displayed
Sound � AUX In � Speed Volume � Audio Adjusting the setting to 0 (zero) turns off the when the audio unit is turned off either by
Default speed volume feature. Increasing the speed pushing the power button or when the ignition
Push the ENTER button to select the setting volume setting results in the audio volume switch is placed in the “OFF” position.
you want to change. Turn the MENU knob to increasing more rapidly with vehicle speed. Format:
adjust the selected item. once chosen, press Enter button to save the
setting. Switch the clock display between 24-hour
Sound: mode and 12-hour clock mode.
Audio Default menu:
Adjust Bass, Treble, Balance and Fade. Turn the Radio setting:
MENU knob and then push the ENTER button to The audio unit has a saved preset settings as a D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
select the setting item. Turn the MENU knob to factory default. Select “Yes” to change all Push the button to enter the setup menu
adjust the setting. settings back to the factory preset settings. screen and then select “Radio”.
Select “No” to exit the menu keeping the This function is used to select the FM frequency
. Bass: current settings. band.
Enhances or attenuates the bass response
sound. Language setting:
D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
. Treble: After the desired settings have been set, push Push the button to enter the setup menu
Enhances or attenuates the treble. either the button or the button screen and then select “Language”.
continuously, and wait for 10 seconds without
. Balance: pushing any other buttons to exit the menu Select the appropriate language and push the
Adjusts the balance of the volume between screen. ENTER button. Upon completion, the screen will
the left and right speakers. automatically adapt the language setting.
. Fade: Clock setting:
D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
Adjusts the balance of the volume between Push the button to enter the setup menu Day/Night button:
the front and rear (if equipped) speakers. screen and then select “Clock”. D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
AUX In: Turn the MENU knob, and the mode will change Push the Day/Night button to switch the dis-
as follows. play brightness between the daytime and
Adjusts the volume output from the auxiliary nighttime modes.
source. Set Time � ON/OFF � Format
Speed Vol.: Set Time: MUTE button:
Set the audio system to automatically adjust Select “Set Time” and then adjust the clock as D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
the volume level in relation to vehicle speed. follows. Push the MUTE button to mute the audio
system. Push again to restored the sound.
Turn the MENU knob counterclockwise or The hour display will start flashing. Turn the
clockwise to adjust the volume, higher (more) MENU knob to adjust the hour and push the
bars mean the volume level relatively changes ENTER button. The minute display will start
more when the vehicle speed increase or flashing. Turn the MENU knob to adjust the
To select a preferred folder: along with the track title as follows. . Quick search
1. Push the ENTER button or the button, Track time ? Artist ? Album ? Track time . (Seek/track)
and a list of tracks in the current folder is Track details: . MIX (Random play)
displayed. . RPT (Repeat track)
Pushing and holding the button will turn
2. Push the button. the display into a detailed overview. Push the . Folder browsing
3. Turn the MENU knob for the preferred button to return to the display for the main
folder. display mode. MEDIA button:
D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
4. Push the ENTER button to access the To change to the USB mode, push the
folder. Push the ENTER button again to CD eject button: button with a USB connected until the USB
start playing the first track or turn the D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
mode is selected.
MENU knob, and push the ENTER button to When the button is pushed while a CD is
select another track. loaded, the CD will be ejected.
When the ignition switch is placed in the “OFF” DISP button:
If the current selected folder contains sub D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
folders, push the ENTER button, and a new or “LOCK” position it is possible to eject the CD While a track with recorded music information
screen with a list of sub folders will be currently being played. However the audio unit tags (ID3-tags) is being played, the title of the
displayed. Turn the MENU knob for the sub will not be activated. played track is displayed. If the tags are not
folder and then push the ENTER button to If a CD is ejected by pushing the button, provided then a notification message is dis-
select. Select the root folder item when songs and it is not taken out from the loading slot played.
are recorded additionally in the root folder. within 20 seconds, the CD will automatically be When the button is pushed continuously,
To return to the previous folder screen, push reloaded to the slot in order to protect the CD. further information about the track can be
the button. displayed along with the track title as follows.
USB (Universal Serial Bus) connection
port Track time ? Artist ? Album ? Track time
RPT button: GUID-DED64B54-7674-44A9-9B63-FE6451C3BF9B
D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8 The USB connection port is located on the Track details:
Push the button and the current track will lower part of the instrument panel. See “USB Pushing and holding the button will turn
be played continuously. (Universal Serial Bus) connection port” (P.4-74). the display into a detailed overview. Push the
Connect a USB memory device into the con- button to return to the display for the main
MIX button: nection port. The system will switch to the USB display mode.
D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8 memory device mode automatically.
Push the button and all the tracks will be If the system has been turned off while the USB iPod player operation
GUID-4227010C-EDC8-4805-8414-4694B7255E14
played in a random order. memory device was playing, pushing the power ConnectingD23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
iPod:
button will start the USB memory device. Connect the iPod to the USB connection port
DISP button: The following operations are identical to the using the USB cable that came with your iPod.
D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
audio main operation of the Compact Disc (CD) The USB connection port is located on the
While a CD with title information is being
operation. For details, see “CD player operation” lower part of the instrument panel. See “USB
played, the title of the played track is displayed.
(P.4-41). (Universal Serial Bus) connection port” (P.4-74).
When the button is pushed repeatedly
. List view When the iPod is connected to the vehicle, the
while a CD with MP3/WMA is playing, further
information about the track can be displayed iPod music library can only be operated by the
direction before inserting the device.) The AUX input jack is located on the lower part
menu list screen. of the instrument panel. See “AUX (auxiliary)
. Do not leave the USB cable in a place . Playlists input jack” (P.4-75). The AUX input jack accepts
where it can be pulled unintentionally. any standard analog audio input such as from
Pulling the cable may damage the port. . Artist
. Albums a portable cassette tape/CD player, MP3 player
Refer to your device manufacturer’s owner or laptop computer.
. Tracks
information regarding the proper use and care Push the button to play a compatible
. More
of the device. device when it is plugged into the AUX input
For further information about each item, see jack.
Compatibility:
D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
the iPod owner’s manual.
The system unit shall be compatible with all NISSAN strongly recommends using a stereo
The following operations are identical to the mini plug cable when connecting your music
devices (past and future) supporting Apple audio main operation of the Compact Disc (CD)
Accessory Protocol on USB link. device to the audio system. Music may not play
operation. For details, see “CD player operation” properly when a monaural cable is used.
It includes (and not limited to): (P.4-41).
. iPod Generation 5 devices . List view WARNING:
. iPod Classic I and II (Generation 6 and 7) . Quick search
Do not allow the cable or an external device
connected to the AUX terminal to affect your
driving.
JVH1078X
Anti-theft system (if equipped) . If the wrong code is entered after the third
GUID-1EC56843-F038-4E78-B995-B09CAD07EFB9
attempt, the audio unit will lock for 60
Use of a 4-digit radio PIN (Personal Identifica-
minutes. The display will show a count
tion Number) code, known only to the vehicle
down timer from 60 to 0 (minutes). After
owner, effectively reduces the possibility of the
60 minutes enter the correct radio code.
audio unit being stolen. Without the PIN code
the audio unit cannot be activated. . If the wrong code is entered after eight sets
of three entries, the audio unit will lock
If force is used to try and remove the audio unit, permanently. Contact a NISSAN dealer for
the Anti-theft system activates and the audio further details.
unit is locked. The only way to unlock the audio
unit is to enter the radio code number shown Audio mainGUID-5E6C21DA-B0A8-474F-ACAE-B3D4580BE99A
operation
on an identification card supplied with the JVH0832X The audio system operates when the ignition
vehicle documentation.
switch is placed in the “ON” or “ACC” position.
1. Place the ignition switch in the “ACC” or
NOTE: Power/VOL dial:
“ON” position. D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
. The 4 digit radio code is shown on a card
that you received with your vehicle doc- 2. “Radio Code” is displayed along with four Power ON/OFF:
umentation. numerical zero digits. To turn on the audio system, push the Power/
. Contact a NISSAN dealer if you do lose the 3. Push preset the number of times corre- VOL dial.
4 digit radio code of the audio unit. sponding with the first digit of the radio The system will turn on in the mode, which was
code. used immediately before the system was
Unlocking the unit:
D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
For example, if the radio code is 5169: for turned off.
If the battery supply to the vehicle is inter- the first digit, “5”, push the preset five
rupted, the audio unit will lock. To turn off the audio system, push the Power/
times. VOL dial.
When the power is restored and the unit 4. The second, third, and fourth digits of the
switched on, the display will show “Radio Code” Volume control:
radio code must be entered in the same
and it will be unlocked when the codes have To control the volume, turn the Power/VOL dial.
way, only now using preset , , and .
been entered correctly. Turn the Power/VOL dial clockwise to make the
For example, push once, six times, and
sound louder.
nine times.
Unlocking procedure: Turn the Power/VOL dial counterclockwise to
5. Push the MENU/ENTER dial to confirm
Read this section very carefully. It is important make the sound quieter.
the code. If you entered the code correctly
that the instructions are followed precisely. the unit will switch on.
To unlock the audio unit, proceed as follows: 6. If the code is entered incorrectly a notifica- SETUP button:
D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
tion message “Incorrect Pin”, “Please re- To configure Audio, Clock, Radio, or Language
enter Pin” and the number of attempts left settings, perform the following procedure:
[Remaining Tries: xx] will be shown.
1. Push the SETUP button.
After reading the message, push the MENU/
ENTER dial to return to the entry screen and 2. Turn the MENU/ENTER dial, the display will
enter the correct radio code. appear in the following order:
Audio ? Clock ? Radio ? Language
3. Push the MENU/ENTER dial. the speed volume feature. Radio setting:
After the desired levels have been set, push the . Bass Boost: Turn the MENU/ENTER dial until the Radio is
Back button repeatedly or push the SETUP Turn on or off the Bass Boost feature which displayed, and push the MENU/ENTER dial.
button. emphasizes the lower audio frequencies. The FM station which can be received will be
Audio adjustments: . Audio Default: updated.
Turn the MENU/ENTER dial until the Audio is The audio unit has a saved preset settings Language setting:
displayed, and push the MENU/ENTER dial. as a factory default. Select “Yes” to change
all settings back to the factory preset Turn the MENU/ENTER dial until the Language
Each time the MENU/ENTER dial is pushed, the settings. Select “No” to exit the menu is displayed, and push the MENU/ENTER dial.
mode will change as follows: keeping the current settings. Select the appropriate language and push the
Sound ? AUX In? Speed Vol. ? Bass Boost ? Clock setting: MENU/ENTER dial. Upon completion, the screen
Audio Default will automatically adapt the language setting.
Turn the MENU/ENTER dial until the Clock is
Turn the MENU/ENTER dial clockwise or coun- displayed, and push the MENU/ENTER dial.
terclockwise to adjust the following items and Day/Night button:
Turn the MENU/ENTER dial, the mode will
push MENU/ENTER dial to confirm. D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
change as follows: Push the Day/Night button to switch the dis-
. Sound: play brightness between the daytime and
Set Time ? ON/OFF ? Format
Bass: nighttime modes.
. Set Time
Use this control to enhance or attenuate The switches on the audio unit will also
bass response sound. Select “Set Time” then adjust the clock as
follows: illuminate in the nighttime mode.
Treble:
The hour display will start flashing. Turn the
Use this control to enhance or attenuate
MENU/ENTER dial to adjust the hour and Phone button:
the treble. D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
push the MENU/ENTER dial. The minute
Bal. (Balance) : display will start flashing. Turn the MENU/ For operation on how to use phone button, see
Use this control to adjust the balance of the ENTER dial to adjust the minute and push “Bluetooth® Hands-Free Phone System (Type
volume between the left and right speak- the MENU/ENTER dial to finish the clock A)” (P.4-77).
ers. adjustment.
Fade: . ON/OFF MEDIA button:
D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
Use this control to adjust the balance of the The clock display can be turned on and off. Push the MEDIA button to play a compatible
volume between the front and the rear When “ON” is selected, the clock will be device when it is connected.
speakers. displayed. (The clock will keep being dis-
. AUX In: played even after the power of the audio Each time the MEDIA button is pushed, the
unit is turned off). When “OFF” is selected, audio source will change.
Use this control to adjust the volume out-
put from the auxiliary source. the clock will not be displayed.
. Speed Vol. (Volume) : . Format
This mode controls the volume output Switch the clock display between 24-hour
from the speakers automatically in relation mode and 12-hour clock mode.
to vehicle speed.
Adjusting the setting to 0 (zero) turns off
Radio operation To change the radio bands, push the RADIO audio fuse blows, the station memory will be
GUID-FFE2D05C-7F4D-4D24-98FC-BD11CF0784C9
button until the desired band appears. erased. In such a case, reset the desired
Frequency D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
range and step change: stations.
FM 1 ? FM 2 ? AM ? FM 1
To change the frequency range and step
specification of the radio, perform the following When the RADIO button is pushed for more Radio Data System (RDS) operation (if
operations. than 1.5 seconds, the six stations with the equipped): D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
strongest signals are stored in the preset (1 to The RDS is a system through which encoded
1. Turn on the audio system. 6) buttons of the band. During the search, a digital information is transmitted by FM radio
2. Push the RADIO button and select AM or FM notification message appears on the display stations in addition to the normal FM radio
mode. and the sound is muted until the operation is broadcasting. The RDS provides information
3. Push and hold the SETUP button for more complete. Once completed, the radio selects services such as station name, traffic informa-
than 3 seconds. preset button. tion, or news.
4. After the 3 seconds, keep holding the NOTE:
SETUP button and turn the MENU/ENTER Seek/track buttons:
dial counterclockwise until you hear 3
D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8 In some countries or regions, some of these
Push or button briefly to manually services may not be available.
clicks, clockwise until you hear 3 clicks, change the frequency.
and then counterclockwise until you hear 3 Alternative Frequency (AF) mode
clicks. To adjust the broadcasting station frequency
automatically, push and hold the or The AF mode operates in the FM (radio) mode.
5. Turn the MENU/ENTER dial until “Region” is button. When the system detects a broad- The AF function compares signal strengths and
highlighted, and push the MENU/ENTER casting station, it will stop at the station. selects the station with the optimum reception
dial. conditions for the currently tuned-in station.
6. Select an appropriate region from the &
1 &
2 &
3 &
4 & 5 & 6 Station memory buttons:
D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
following options:
During radio reception, pushing the station RDS functions
. EUR memory button for less than 2 seconds will
. GOM Pacific When an RDS station is tuned in with seek or
select the stored radio station.
manual tuning, the RDS data is received and
. GOM S. America The audio system can store up to 12 FM station the Programme Service (PS) name is displayed.
7. To apply the setting, turn off the audio frequencies (6 in each of FM 1 and FM 2 ) and 6
system, place the ignition switch in the AM station frequencies. CD player operation
GUID-F0A1999A-2BAB-44C0-9578-046512E59485
“OFF” position, and then place the ignition To store the station frequency manually: Loading: D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
switch back in the “ON” position.
1. Tune to the desired broadcasting station Insert a CD into the slot with the label side
frequency by using the Seek/track buttons. facing up. The CD will be guided automatically
RADIO button: 2. Push and hold a station memory button & 1 into the slot and will start playing. After loading
D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
When the RADIO button is pushed while the -& 6 until a beep sounds. the CD, the number of tracks and the playtime
audio system is off, the audio system will turn will appear on the display.
3. The channel indicator will display, indicat-
on and the radio will turn on. ing that the memory is stored properly.
When the RADIO button is pushed while an- 4. Perform steps 1 - 3 for all other memory
other audio source is playing, the other audio buttons.
source will turn off and the radio will turn on.
If the battery cable is disconnected, or if the
Monitor, air conditioner, audio and phone system 4-47
FM-AM RADIO WITH COMPACT DISC (CD) PLAYER (Type C) Anti-theft system (if equipped)
GUID-511AFA96-B723-43D0-9398-AE777EE3FB2E
GUID-34C79B2A-B871-4EED-A5E4-2FC6C0AA5378
Use of a 4-digit radio PIN (Personal Identifica-
tion Number) code, known only to the vehicle
owner, effectively reduces the possibility of the
audio unit being stolen. Without the PIN code
the audio unit cannot be activated.
If force is used to try and remove the audio unit,
the Anti-theft system activates and the audio
unit is locked. The only way to unlock the audio
unit is to enter the radio code number shown
on an identification card supplied with the
vehicle documentation.
NOTE:
. The 4 digit radio code is shown on a card
that you received with your vehicle doc-
umentation.
. Contact a NISSAN dealer if you do lose the
4 digit radio code of the audio unit.
Unlocking the unit:
D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
If the battery supply to the vehicle is inter-
rupted, the audio unit will lock.
When the power is restored and the unit
switched on, the display will show “Radio Code”
and it will be unlocked when the codes have
been entered correctly.
JVH1079X
Unlocking procedure:
1. AM button 9. CD eject button Read this section very carefully. It is important
2. FM button 10. MEDIA button that the instructions are followed precisely.
3. Day/Night button 11. DISP (Display) button To unlock the audio unit, proceed as follows:
4. Seek/track (rewind) button 12. Power/VOL (Volume) dial
5. Seek/track (fast forward) button 13. Station memory buttons
6. RPT (repeat) ·MIX button 14. A-Z button
7. SETUP button 15. MENU/ENTER dial
8. Back button
. If the wrong code is entered after the third 3. Push the MENU/ENTER dial.
attempt, the audio unit will lock for 60 After the desired levels have been set, push the
minutes. The display will show a count Back button repeatedly or push the SETUP
down timer from 60 to 0 (minutes). After button.
60 minutes enter the correct radio code.
Audio adjustments:
. If the wrong code is entered after eight sets
of three entries, the audio unit will lock Turn the MENU/ENTER dial until the Audio is
permanently. Contact a NISSAN dealer for displayed, and push the MENU/ENTER dial.
further details. Each time the MENU/ENTER dial is pushed, the
mode will change as follows:
Audio main operation
GUID-C820DAB5-7FF4-4932-8101-07A42040B1AA
Sound ? AUX In? Speed Vol. ? Bass Boost ?
JVH0832X The audio system operates when the ignition Audio Default
switch is placed in the “ON” or “ACC” position.
1. Place the ignition switch in the “ACC” or Turn the MENU/ENTER dial clockwise or coun-
“ON” position. Power/VOL dial:
D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8 terclockwise to adjust the following items and
2. “Radio Code” is displayed along with four Power ON/OFF: push MENU/ENTER dial to confirm.
numerical zero digits. To turn on the audio system, push the Power/ . Sound menu
3. Push preset the number of times corre- VOL dial. Bass:
sponding with the first digit of the radio The system will turn on in the mode, which was Use this control to enhance or attenuate
code. used immediately before the system was bass response sound.
For example, if the radio code is 5169: for turned off. Treble:
the first digit, “5”, push the preset five To turn off the audio system, push the Power/ Use this control to enhance or attenuate
times. VOL dial. the treble.
4. The second, third, and fourth digits of the Volume control: Bal. (Balance) :
radio code must be entered in the same Use this control to adjust the balance of the
To control the volume, turn the Power/VOL dial.
way, only now using preset , , and . volume between the left and right speak-
Turn the Power/VOL dial clockwise to make the ers.
For example, push once, six times, and
sound louder. Fade:
nine times.
Turn the Power/VOL dial counterclockwise to Use this control to adjust the balance of the
5. Push the MENU/ENTER dial to confirm
make the sound quieter. volume between the front and the rear
the code. If you entered the code correctly
the unit will switch on. speakers.
SETUP button: . AUX In menu
6. If the code is entered incorrectly a notifica- D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
tion message “Incorrect Pin”, “Please re- Use this control to adjust the volume out-
To configure Audio, Clock, Radio, or Language
enter Pin” and the number of attempts left put from the auxiliary source.
settings, perform the following procedure:
[Remaining Tries: xx] will be shown. . Speed Vol. (Volume) menu
1. Push the SETUP button.
After reading the message, push the MENU/ This mode controls the volume output
ENTER dial to return to the entry screen and 2. Turn the MENU/ENTER dial, the display will from the speakers automatically in relation
enter the correct radio code. appear in the following order: to vehicle speed.
Audio ? Clock ? Radio ? Language Adjusting the setting to 0 (zero) turns off
the speed volume feature. Radio setting: 3. Push and hold the SETUP button for more
. Bass Boost menu Turn the MENU/ENTER dial until the Radio is than 3 seconds.
Turn on or off the Bass Boost feature which displayed, and push the MENU/ENTER dial. 4. After the 3 seconds, keep holding the
emphasizes the lower audio frequencies. The FM station which can be received will be SETUP button and turn the MENU/ENTER
. Audio Default menu updated. dial counterclockwise until you hear 3
The audio unit has a saved preset settings clicks, clockwise until you hear 3 clicks,
Language setting: and then counterclockwise until you hear 3
as a factory default. Select “Yes” to change
all settings back to the factory preset Turn the MENU/ENTER dial until the Language clicks.
settings. Select “No” to exit the menu is displayed, and push the MENU/ENTER dial. 5. Turn the MENU/ENTER dial until “Region” is
keeping the current settings. Select the appropriate language and push the highlighted, and push the MENU/ENTER
Clock setting: MENU/ENTER dial. Upon completion, the screen dial.
will automatically adapt the language setting. 6. Select an appropriate region from the
Turn the MENU/ENTER dial until the Clock is
displayed, and push the MENU/ENTER dial. following options:
Turn the MENU/ENTER dial, the mode will Day/Night button: . EUR
D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
change as follows: . GOM Pacific
Push the Day/Night button to switch the dis-
Set Time ? ON/OFF ? Format play brightness between the daytime and . GOM S. America
. Set Time nighttime modes. 7. To apply the setting, turn off the audio
Select “Set Time” then adjust the clock as The switches on the audio unit will illuminate in system, place the ignition switch in the
follows: the nighttime mode. “OFF” position, and then place the ignition
switch back in the “ON” position.
The hour display will start flashing. Turn the
MENU/ENTER dial to adjust the hour and MEDIA button:
push the MENU/ENTER dial. The minute D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8 AM/FM buttons:
display will start flashing. Turn the MENU/ Push the MEDIA button to play a compatible D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
device when it is connected. When the AM or the FM button is pushed while
ENTER dial to adjust the minute and push
the audio system is off, the audio system will
the MENU/ENTER dial to finish the clock Each time the MEDIA button is pushed, the
turn on and the radio will turn on.
adjustment. audio source will change.
. ON/OFF When the AM or the FM button is pushed while
The clock display can be turned on and off.
Radio operation
GUID-5A300D73-97F8-4E8F-88B6-82E9A2347320
another audio source is playing, the other
audio source will turn off and the radio will
When “ON” is selected, the clock will be Frequency D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
range and step change:
turn on.
displayed. (The clock will keep being dis- To change the frequency range and step
played even after the power of the audio To change the radio bands, push the FM button
specification of the radio, perform the following
unit is turned off). When “OFF” is selected, until the desired band appears.
operations.
the clock will not be displayed. FM 1 ? FM 2 ? FM 1
1. Turn on the audio system.
. Format When the AM or the FM button is pushed for
Switch the clock display between 24-hour 2. Push the FM or the AM button and select
more than 1.5 seconds, the six stations with the
mode and 12-hour clock mode. AM or FM mode.
strongest signals are stored in the preset (1 to
6) buttons of the band. During the search, a
notification message appears on the display
and the sound is muted until the operation is Radio Data System (RDS) operation (if NOTE:
complete. Once completed, the radio selects equipped): D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8 . The CD player accepts normal audio CDs
preset button. or CDs containing MP3/WMA files.
The RDS is a system through which encoded
digital information is transmitted by FM radio . The audio unit will automatically detect if
Seek/track buttons: stations in addition to the normal FM radio a CD containing MP3/WMA files is in-
D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8 broadcasting. The RDS provides information serted, and “MP3CD” will be indicated.
Push or button briefly to manually services such as station name, traffic informa- . An error notification message will be
change the frequency. tion, or news. displayed when inserting an incompati-
To adjust the broadcasting station frequency ble disc type (e.g. DVD), or if the player
automatically, push and hold the or NOTE: cannot read the CD. Eject the disc and
button. When the system detects a broad- In some countries or regions, some of these insert another disc.
casting station, it will stop at the station. services may not be available.
Alternative Frequency (AF) mode MEDIA button:
&
1 &
2 &
3 &
4 & 5 & 6 Station memory buttons: D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8 The AF mode operates in the FM (radio) mode. To change to the CD mode, push the MEDIA
During radio reception, pushing the station
memory button for less than 2 seconds will The AF function compares signal strengths and button with a CD inserted until the CD mode is
select the stored radio station. selects the station with the optimum reception selected.
conditions for the currently tuned-in station.
The audio system can store up to 12 FM station List view: D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
frequencies (6 in each of FM 1 and FM 2 ) and 6 While the track is being played, push the MENU/
AM station frequencies. RDS functions ENTER dial to display the available tracks in a
To store the station frequency manually: When an RDS station is tuned in with seek or listed view mode. To select a track from the list,
manual tuning, the RDS data is received and turn the MENU/ENTER dial then push MENU/
1. Tune to the desired broadcasting station ENTER dial.
frequency by using the Seek/track buttons. the Programme Service (PS) name is displayed.
2. Push and hold a station memory button & 1 Quick search:
CD player operation D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
-& 6 until a beep sounds. (The radio mutes GUID-01B27D57-56B4-4AA5-9947-8732605BCF6A
In the list view mode, a quick search can be
when the memory button is pushed.) Loading: D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8 performed to find a track from the list. Push the
3. The channel indicator will display and the Insert a CD into the slot with the label side A-Z button, turn the MENU/ENTER dial to the
radio mute disengages, indicating that the facing up. The CD will be guided automatically first alphabetic letter of the song title and then
memory is stored properly. into the slot and will start playing. After loading push the MENU/ENTER dial. When found, a list
the CD, the number of tracks and the playtime of the available songs will be displayed. Select,
4. Perform steps 1 - 3 for all other memory will appear on the display. and push the MENU/ENTER dial to play the
buttons. preferred track.
If the battery cable is disconnected, or if the CAUTION:
audio fuse blows, the station memory will be Seek/track button:
erased. In such a case, reset the desired Do not force the CD into the slot. This could D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
stations. damage the player. Push and hold the or button to fast
forward or rewind through the track. When the
button is released, the track will play at normal
playing speed.
. RPT (Repeat track) Compatibility: audio main operation of the Compact Disc (CD)
D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
. Folder browsing The system unit shall be compatible with all operation. For details, see “CD player operation”
devices (past and future) supporting Apple (P.4-54).
MEDIA button: Accessory Protocol on USB link. . List view
D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
It includes (and not limited to): . Quick search
To operate the USB memory device, push the . (Seek/track)
MEDIA button repeatedly until the USB mode is . iPod Generation 5 devices
selected. . iPod Classic I and II (Generation 6 and 7) . MIX (Random play)
. iTouch Generation OS 1, 2, 3, 4 and next . RPT (Repeat track)
. iPhone Generation OS 1, 2, 3, 4 and next . Folder browsing
DISP button:
D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
. iPod Nano (1G, 2G, 3G)
While a track with recorded music information DISP button:
tags (ID3-tags) is being played, the title of the . iPad 1, 2 and 3 D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
played track is displayed. NOTE: While a track with recorded music information
When the DISP button is pushed repeatedly, tags (ID3-tags) is being played, the title of the
This audio system do not support iPad played track is displayed.
further information about the track can be charging.
displayed along with the track title as follows: When the DISP button is pushed repeatedly,
Track time ? Artist ? Album ? Track time MEDIA button: further information about the track can be
D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8 displayed along with the track title as follows:
Track details: To operate the iPod, push the MEDIA button Track time ? Artist ? Album ? Track time
Pushing and holding the DISP button will turn repeatedly until the USB (iPod) mode is selected
the display into a detailed overview. Push the and then push the MENU/ENTER dial. Track details:
Back button to return to the display for the Pushing and holding the DISP button will turn
main display mode. iPod main operation:
D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8 the display into a detailed overview. To return
Interface: to the main display, push the Back button.
iPod player operation
GUID-81FA4C5E-B85C-42C5-B696-CD94E3F1EED7 The interface for iPod operation shown on the
audio system display is similar to the iPod AUX device player operation
ConnectingD23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
iPod: GUID-4EC0B7FE-328B-4322-A78A-40941A841162
interface. Use the MENU/ENTER dial to play a The AUX jack is located on lower part of the
Connect the iPod to the USB connection port instrument panel. See “AUX (auxiliary) input
track on the iPod.
using the USB cable that came with your iPod. jack” (P.4-75). The AUX input jack accepts any
The following items can be chosen from the
The USB connection port is located on the standard analog audio input such as from a
menu list screen.
lower part of the instrument panel. See “USB portable cassette tape/CD player, MP3 player
(Universal Serial Bus) connection port” (P.4-74). . Playlists or laptop computer.
When the iPod is connected to the vehicle, the . Artists NISSAN strongly recommends using a stereo
iPod music library can only be operated by the . Albums mini plug cable when connecting your music
vehicle audio controls. . Tracks device to the audio system. Music may not play
* iPod and iPhone are a trademark of Apple Inc., . More properly when a monaural cable is used.
registered in the U.S. and other countries. For further information about each item, see
the iPod owner’s manual.
The following operations are identical to the
JVH0924X
17. ENTER/SETTING button . Brightness and Contrast Select the “On-Screen Clock” using the
Adjust the brightness and contrast of the TUNE·FOLDER dial and then push the
Audio main operation
GUID-11DCE3A7-6F47-41AC-BBA5-B5E61368B3B3 screen. ENTER/SETTING button. You can toggle
Head unit: D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8 Select the “Brightness” or “Contrast” using between ON and OFF using the TUNE·-
the TUNE·FOLDER dial and then push the FOLDER dial.
The auto loudness circuit enhances the low
and high frequency ranges automatically. ENTER/SETTING button. Turn the TUNE·- . RDS Display
FOLDER dial to adjust the brightness and RDS (radio data system) information can be
Power/VOL dial:
D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8 contrast of the screen to the preferred shown on the display. Select “RDS Display”
The power of the audio system can be turned level. using the TUNE·FOLDER dial and then push
on when the ignition switch is placed in the . Clock Adjust the ENTER/SETTING button. You can toggle
“ON” or “ACC” position. Push the power/VOL dial Adjust the clock according to the following between ON and OFF using the TUNE·-
while the system is off to turn on the last audio procedure. FOLDER dial.
source, which was playing immediately before . Speed Sensitive Vol.
the system was turned off. While the system is To change the Speed Sensitive Volume
on, pushing the power/VOL dial turns the (Speed Sensitive Vol.) level from off (0) to
system off. 5, turn the TUNE·FOLDER dial.
Turn the power/VOL dial to adjust the volume. . AUX Vol.
Audio settings: Controls the volume level of incoming
D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8 sound when an auxiliary device is con-
The settings screen will appear when pushing nected to the system. Choose a setting
the ENTER/SETTING button. between 1 and 3 or choose 0 to disable the
The following items are available in the settings feature entirely.
screen. . Language Select
. Bluetooth JVH0729X The language settings can be changed.
It is possible to set the Bluetooth® settings. Select “Language Select” using the TUNE·-
For details of the Bluetooth® settings, see 1) Select “Clock Adjust” using the TUNE·- FOLDER dial and then push the ENTER/
“Bluetooth® audio player operation” (P.4- FOLDER dial and then push the SETTING button. Use the TUNE·FOLDER dial
62). ENTER/SETTING button . to select the preferred language.
. Bass, Treble, Balance and Fade 2) Adjust the hour with the TUNE·FOLDER
dial and then push the ENTER/
Controls the sound of the audio system. SETTING button . DISP button:
Balance adjusts the sound between the left D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
and right speakers. Fade adjusts the sound 3) Adjust the minute with the TUNE·- . Model without Around View Monitor
between the front and rear speakers. FOLDER dial and then push the Display of the screen can be turned off by
ENTER/SETTING button . pushing the DISP button. You can still listen
Select the “Bass”, “Treble”, “Balance” or
“Fade” using the TUNE·FOLDER dial and 24 hour clock is not available. to music that is being played back even
then push the ENTER/SETTING button. . On-Screen Clock while the screen display is turned off. If you
Turn the TUNE·FOLDER dial to adjust the When this item is turned on, a clock is want to display the screen again, push the
Bass, Treble, balance and Fade of the always displayed in the upper right corner DISP button once more. Pushing some of
screen to the preferred level. of the screen. the audio source buttons will also turn the
screen back on and display the screens of
the corresponding sources. . Music or programming type such as “Clas- CD player operation
GUID-6FF17468-33BE-4711-8C16-B04EDEC36E69
. Model with Around View Monitor sical”, “Country” or “Rock”.
Place the ignition switch in the “ON” or “ACC”
The Around View Monitor can be displayed position. Insert the Compact Disc (CD) into the
by pushing the DISP button. To display the SEEK tuning buttons: slot with the label side facing up. The CD will be
audio screen again, push the DISP button D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
guided automatically into the slot and start
repeatedly. Pushing some of the audio Push the or button to tune from low to playing.
source buttons can also display the audio high or high to low frequencies and to stop at
the next broadcasting station. After loading the CD, the number of tracks on
screen. For details about the Around View
the CD and the play time will appear on the
Monitor, see “Around View Monitor” (P.4-13).
display.
SCAN tuning buttons:
D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8 If the radio is already operating, it will auto-
MEDIA button: Push the SCAN tuning button to tune from low matically turn off and the CD will play.
D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
Pushing the MEDIA button will switch the audio to high frequencies and stop at each broad- If the system has been turned off while the CD
source as follows: casting station for 5 seconds. Pushing the was playing, pushing the power/VOL dial will
button again during this 5 seconds period will start the CD.
USB/iPod ? Bluetooth ? AUX ? USB/iPod stop SCAN tuning and the radio will remain
Radio operation tuned to that station.
GUID-A3B70A0E-E243-4FF1-8AF5-144FBFE8AE3C CD button:
If the SCAN tuning button is not pushed within D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
5 seconds, SCAN tuning moves to the next When the CD button is pushed with the system
FM·AM button:
D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8 station. off and the CD loaded, the system will turn on
Pushing the FM·AM button will change the and the CD will start to play.
to D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
Station memory buttons:
band as follows: When the CD button is pushed with the CD
12 stations can be set for the FM band (6 each
AM ? FM1 ? FM2 ? AM for FM1 and FM2) and 6 stations can be set for loaded and the radio playing, the radio will
the AM band. automatically be turned off and the CD will
TUNE (Tuning):
D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8 start to play.
Turn the radio TUNE·FOLDER dial for manual 1. Choose the radio band using the FM·AM
tuning. button.
SEEK/TRACK:
Radio Data D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
System (RDS): 2. Tune to the desired station using the D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
or button or the TUNE·FOLDER dial. When the or button is pushed for more
RDS stands for Radio Data System, and is a than 1.5 seconds while the CD is being played,
data information service transmitted by some 3. Push and hold the desired station preset
button to until the radio mutes. the CD will play while fast forwarding or
radio stations on the FM band (not AM band) rewinding. When the button is released, the
encoded within a regular radio broadcast. 4. The station indicator will then come on and CD will return to normal play speed.
Currently, most RDS stations are in large cities, the sound will resume. Memorizing is now
but many stations are now considering broad- complete. When the or button is pushed for less
casting RDS data. than 1.5 seconds while the CD is being played,
5. Other buttons can be set in the same the next track or the beginning of the current
RDS can display: manner. track on the CD will be played.
. Station name, such as “The Groove”. If the battery cable is disconnected, or if the
fuse opens, the station memory will be erased.
In that case, reset the desired stations.
NISSAN strongly recommends using a stereo FM-AM RADIO WITH COMPACT DISC (CD) PLAYER (Type E)
mini plug cable when connecting your music GUID-D505B13C-F413-4129-9BCF-2DFFD22BE550
device to the audio system. Music may not play
properly when a monaural cable is used.
JVH0673X
17. ENTER/SETTING button the TUNE·FOLDER dial and then push the . RDS Display (if equipped)
ENTER/SETTING button. Turn the TUNE·- RDS (radio data system) information can be
Audio main GUID-A2237C6F-84BB-40E2-9692-7ACFDB5B1A9D
operation FOLDER dial to adjust the brightness and shown on the display. Select “RDS Display”
The audio system operates when the ignition contrast of the screen to the preferred using the TUNE·FOLDER dial and then push
switch is placed in the “ON” or “ACC” position. level. the ENTER/SETTING button. You can toggle
Head unit: D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8 . Clock Adjust between ON and OFF using the TUNE·-
Adjust the clock according to the following FOLDER dial.
The auto loudness circuit enhances the low procedure. . Speed Sensitive Vol.
and high frequency ranges automatically.
To change the Speed Sensitive Volume
Power/VOL dial:
D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
(Speed Sens Vol.) level from off (0) to 5,
Push Power/VOL dial to turn on and off the turn the TUNE·FOLDER dial.
audio system. . AUX Vol.
Turn the Power/VOL dial to adjust the volume. Controls the volume level of incoming
sound when an auxiliary device is con-
Audio settings:
D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8 nected to the system. Choose a setting
The settings screen will appear when pushing between 1 and 3 or choose 0 to disable the
the ENTER/SETTING button. feature entirely.
The following items are available in the settings . Language Select
screen. The language settings can be changed.
JVH0653X
. Bluetooth Select “Language Select” using the TUNE·-
1) Select “Clock Adjust” using the TUNE·- FOLDER dial and then push the ENTER/
It is possible to set the Bluetooth® settings.
FOLDER dial and then push the SETTING button. Use the TUNE·FOLDER dial
For details of the Bluetooth® settings, see
ENTER/SETTING button . to select the preferred language.
“Bluetooth® audio player operation” (P.4-
67). 2) Adjust the hour with the TUNE·FOLDER
. Bass, Treble, Balance and Fade dial and then push the ENTER/ DISP button:
D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
Controls the sound of the audio system. SETTING button .
Display of the screen can be turned off by
Balance adjusts the sound between the left 3) Adjust the minute with the TUNE·- pushing the DISP button. You can still listen to
and right speakers. Fade adjusts the sound FOLDER dial and then push the music that is being played back even while the
between the front and rear speakers. ENTER/SETTING button . screen display is turned off. If you want to
Select the “Bass”, “Treble”, “Balance” or 24 hour clock is not available. display the screen again, push the DISP button
“Fade” using the TUNE·FOLDER dial and . On-Screen Clock once more. Pushing some of the audio source
then push the ENTER/SETTING button. When this item is turned on, a clock is buttons will also turn the screen back on and
Turn the TUNE·FOLDER dial to adjust the always displayed in the upper right corner display the screens of the corresponding
Bass, Treble, balance and Fade of the of the screen. sources.
screen to the preferred level. Select the “On-Screen Clock” using the
. Brightness and Contrast TUNE·FOLDER dial and then push the
Adjust the brightness and contrast of the ENTER/SETTING button. You can toggle
screen. between ON and OFF using the TUNE·-
Select the “brightness” or “contrast” using FOLDER dial.
CD player operation
MEDIA button: SEEK·TRACK buttons: GUID-916A1F39-ACB2-4A98-9243-C3D3A8031319
D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8 D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8 Place the ignition switch in the “ON” or “ACC”
Pushing the MEDIA button will switch the audio Push the or button to tune from low to position, and insert the Compact Disc (CD) into
source as follows: high or high to low frequencies and to stop at the slot with the label side facing up. The CD
USB/iPod? Bluetooth ? AUX ? USB/iPod the next broadcasting station. will be guided automatically into the slot and
start playing.
Apps button: SCAN tuning button: After loading the CD, the number of tracks on
D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8 the CD and the play time will appear on the
D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
The Apps button launches the Smartphone Push the SCAN tuning button to tune from low display.
Integration mode. See “NissanConnect App to high frequencies and stop at each broad-
casting station for 5 seconds. Pushing the If the radio is already operating, it will auto-
smartphone integration” (P.4-73). matically turn off and the CD will play.
button again during this 5 seconds period will
Radio operation stop SCAN tuning and the radio will remain If the system has been turned off while the CD
GUID-E1E1815D-63F4-4A68-BDCC-576BBBFD3572
tuned to that station. was playing, pushing the Power/VOL dial will
If the SCAN tuning button is not pushed within start the CD.
FM·AM button:
D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8 5 seconds, SCAN tuning moves to the next
Push the FM·AM button to change the band as station. CD button:
follows: D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
to D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
Station memory buttons: When the CD button is pushed with the system
AM ? FM1 ? FM2? AM
12 stations can be set for the FM band (6 each off and the CD loaded, the system will turn on
TUNE (Tuning):
D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
for FM1 and FM2) and 6 stations can be set for and the CD will start to play.
Turn the radio TUNE·FOLDER dial for manual the AM band. When the CD button is pushed with the CD
tuning. 1. Choose the radio band using the FM·AM loaded and the radio playing, the radio will
button. automatically be turned off and the CD will
Radio Data D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
System (RDS) (if equipped):
2. Tune to the desired station using the start to play.
RDS stands for Radio Data System, and is a
data information service transmitted by some or , SCAN tuning button or the
radio stations on the FM band (not AM band) TUNE·FOLDER dial. SEEK·TRACK buttons:
D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
encoded within a regular radio broadcast. 3. Push and hold the desired station preset When the or button is pushed for more
Currently, most RDS stations are in large cities, button to . than 1.5 seconds while the CD is being played,
but many stations are now considering broad- 4. The station indicator will then come on. the CD will play while fast forwarding or
casting RDS data. Memorizing is now complete. rewinding. When the button is released, the
RDS can display: 5. Other buttons can be set in the same CD will return to normal play speed.
. Station name, such as “The Groove”. manner. When the or button is pushed for less
. Music or programming type such as “Clas- If the battery cable is disconnected, or if the than 1.5 seconds while the CD is being played,
sical”, “Country” or “Rock”. fuse opens, the station memory will be erased. the next track or the beginning of the current
In that case, reset the desired stations. track on the CD will be played.
Regulatory D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
information: Bluetooth® D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
audio main operation:
Bluetooth® trademark:
Bluetooth® is a trademark
owned by Bluetooth SIG, Inc.
and licensed to Visteon Cor-
poration.
ConnectingD23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
Bluetooth® device:
To connect your Bluetooth® device to the
vehicle, follow the procedure below:
1. Push the ENTER/SETTING button.
JVH1012X
FM-AM RADIO WITH COMPACT DISC (CD) PLAYER (Type F) Audio main GUID-B7D1A05D-C3DC-4778-9F81-AD04BA1D0557
operation
GUID-44BE771D-EC55-45B4-8C82-BBF64DEF9752
The audio system operates when the ignition
switch is placed in the “ON” or “ACC” position.
Power/VOLUME dial:
D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
Push Power/VOLUME dial to turn on and off the
audio system.
Turn the Power/VOLUME dial to adjust the
volume.
This vehicle may be equipped with Speed
Sensitive Volume (SSV) function for audio.
When this function is turned on, the audio
volume will be adjusted automatically as the
vehicle speed changes. For operations to turn
on and off the SSV function, see “Audio
settings” (P.4-6).
Audio settings:
D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
For the operations to adjust the audio settings,
see “Audio settings” (P.4-6).
Traffic Announcement:
D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
Touch “TA” on the audio screen to turn on or off
the Traffic Information setting. When a traffic
announcement is received, the Traffic Informa-
tion will interrupt the music that was playing
and informs the driver of the received traffic
information.
JVH1072X
Radio operation
GUID-9FD3F554-0F34-4FBE-B3E5-3315DDC726E5
1 Power/VOL (volume) dial 9. AUX (auxiliary) button The audio system operates when the ignition
2. Disc eject button 10. SETUP button switch is placed in the “ON” or “ACC” position.
3. FM·AM button
Radio bandD23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
select button:
4. Disc insert slot
Push the FM·AM button to change the band as
5. BACK button follows:
6. ENTER/Scroll dial AM ? DAB ? FM ? AM
7. CD button If another audio source is playing when the
8. Seek/Track buttons FM·AM button is pushed, the audio source
playing will automatically be turned off and
the last radio station played will begin playing. 3. The channel indicator will then come on CD player operation
GUID-F17D9FC7-7E80-4E00-B071-669FF5441287
and the sound will resume. Programming is
Radio tuning:
D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8 now complete. Loading disc:D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
When in radio mode, the radio can be tuned Insert a CD into the slot with the label side
using the touchscreen. To bring up the visual DAB operation:
D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8 facing up. The CD will be guided automatically
tuner, touch the “Tune” key on the lower part of In the DAB mode, the following operation keys into the slot and will start playing. If the radio is
the screen. A screen appears with a bar and information are available. already playing, it will automatically turn off,
running from low frequencies on the left to . DAB List: and the CD will start playing.
high frequencies on the right.
Touch to display the available station list.
One of the following operations can be used for . TA: CAUTION:
tuning.
Touch this key to turn on and off the TA Do not force the compact disc into the slot.
. Touching the bar on the screen (Traffic Announcement) mode. When This could damage the player.
. Touching “ ”/“ ” on the screen turned on, received TA will interrupt the
. Turning ENTER/Scroll dial audio source that is playing.
To return to the regular radio display screen, . Extra chan.: CD button:
D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
touch the “OK” key. The “Extra chan.” key will allow access to When the CD button is pushed with the system
extra stations transmitted within the group off and the CD loaded, the system will turn on
Station List:D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8 of the currently selected station. If extra and the CD will start to play.
When in FM or DAB (if equipped) mode, touch stations are not available within the group,
“FM List” or “DAB List” to display the station lists. the key will not operate. When the CD button is pushed with a CD
loaded while the radio playing, the radio will
. Radio text:
turned off and the CD will start to play.
Seek/Track buttons: Radio text is shown on the DAB main
D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8 screen underneath the DAB station name.
When in radio mode, push the Seek/Track This displays radio program and song Seek/Track button:
buttons to tune from low to high or high to information as determined by the DAB
D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
low frequencies and to stop at the next broad- When the or button is pushed for more
station. than 1.5 seconds while the CD is being played,
casting station.
EAS in EAS test (displayed on the screen as a the CD will play while fast forwarding or
Station memory keys:
D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
PTY name) is an abbreviation of Emergency rewinding. When the button is released, the
Up to six stations can be stored for AM band, Alert System. CD will return to normal play speed.
and up to twelve stations can be stored for Occasionally, in areas of poor DAB signal When the or button is pushed for less
each of the other bands. strength, the full station name in the DAB List than 1.5 seconds while the CD is being played,
1. Choose the radio band using the FM·AM and DAB main screen might be distorted. In this the next track or the beginning of the current
button. situation it may still be possible to listen to the track on the CD will be played. Push the button
particular radio station, at a reduced level of several times to skip through the tracks on the
2. Tune to the desired station using manual sound quality, but this is not always possible.
or seek tuning. Touch and hold any of the CD. If the last track on a CD is skipped, the first
This may also be shown in the vehicle informa- track on the disc will play. If the last track in a
desired station memory keys until a beep tion display.
sound is heard. folder of an MP3 CD is skipped, the first track of
the next folder will play.
For FM and DAB (if equipped), touch the “7-
12” key to display the 7 - 12 memory keys.
AUX (auxiliary) INPUT JACK mini plug cable when connecting your music USB memory
GUID-BBD1AD38-69B3-4371-A83D-2ED934B3720E D23A131129-A8461194-D397-4FA0-9523-167D72022B4A
device to the audio system. Music may not play
. Do not place heavy objects on the USB
properly when a monaural cable is used.
memory.
CD/USB MEMORY CARE AND CLEANING . Do not store the USB memory in highly
D23A131129-F386FC2F-5971-414B-AB0E-53F33CDC4C3E
humid locations.
CD D23A131129-A7E27739-B9E4-465D-9530-E602D0011802 . Do not expose the USB memory to direct
sunlight.
. Do not spill any liquids on the USB memory.
Refer to the USB memory Owner’s Manual for
details.
SAA0451
ANTENNA
D23A131129-B07FDDFC-EA47-40CE-ADCF-49FC05B0A3F2
RADIO: ROOF ANTENNA . The vehicle enters an automatic car
D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
. Pushing DOWN /UP shorter
GUID-6F68D833-78CB-4E64-AFDE-8BE631134D64 wash.
Next or previous preset channel . The vehicle enters a garage with a low
. Pushing DOWN /UP longer ceiling.
Next or previous station/channel . The vehicle is covered with a car cover.
CD: D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8 PILLAR ANTENNA
GUID-AF0FE1EE-7720-48EC-9BC7-05EA541F24A3
. Pushing DOWN /UP shorter Adjust the antenna length for the best recep-
Next track or the beginning of the current tion. A fully extended antenna is usually best for
track (the previous track if the button is distant reception.
pushed immediately after the current track
starts playing) CAUTION:
. Pushing DOWN /UP longer
Forward or rewind To prevent damage, be sure that the antenna
is retracted before the vehicle enters an
CD with MP3/WMA, iPod, USB device or Blue- automatic car wash.
tooth® audio (if equipped):
D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
. Pushing DOWN /UP shorter
Next track or the beginning of the current
track (the previous track if the button is
pushed immediately after the current track
starts playing)
. Pushing DOWN /UP longer
Folder change (When the last folder is
changed, the next disc will be selected.)
SOURCE D23A131129-6BC3EEB8-5C22-4417-8C25-4D8419A204CC
select switch JVH0666X
Push the SOURCE select switch to change the
mode to available audio source. The antenna can be removed if necessary.
Hold the bottom of the antenna and remove by
Volume D23A131129-B522C2A2-2939-4636-88A9-338DA44D5FD6
control switches turning counterclockwise.
Push the (+) or (−) button to increase To install the antenna, turn the antenna clock-
or decrease the volume. wise and tighten.
CAUTION:
To avoid damaging or deforming the anten-
na, be sure to remove the antenna under the
following conditions.
REGULATORYGUID-B5444140-C5EF-4D29-94F1-86FF505A8251
INFORMATION 2. Back button Bluetooth® SETTINGS
GUID-452CA097-A896-41A8-98C1-BE034F64F2B0
3. Phone button
Bluetooth® GUID-9C05BAE4-DD4E-4AAC-9CEF-20F767C90AF7
trademark 4. MENU/ENTER dial Pairing device
GUID-4C128515-AD83-4D11-8948-344D0BCA3F99
Bluetooth® is a trademark Steering wheel mounted control: Enter the phone setup menu via the
owned by Bluetooth SIG, Inc. button on the instrument panel or the
and licensed to Visteon Cor- button on the steering wheel, select the “Blue-
poration. tooth” key, and then check if the Bluetooth® is
set to on. (If not push the MENU/ENTER dial to
CE statement
GUID-D83F5CFA-1A13-40A8-AC68-51C11222CBB8
turn it on.)
Hereby Visteon Corp. declares that this system To setup the Bluetooth® system to pair (con-
is in compliance with the essential require- nect or register) your preferred cellular phone,
ments and other relevant provisions of Direc- follow the following procedure.
tive 1999/5/EC. 1. To pair a device, select the “Scan device”
key or the “Pair device” key on the display.
2. A notification message will be displayed
NSY0105 when the phone is successfully paired.
JVH0855X
3. The display will return to the current audio
NOTE: 1. Volume control -/ + buttons source status after the connection is com-
The audio system only supports Bluetooth® Push the buttons to increase or decrease plete.
devices with AVRCP (Audio Video Remote the volume of the speakers. . While the Bluetooth® connection is active,
Control Profile) version 1.3, or 1.0 or earlier. 2. Phone send button the following icons will appear on the
CONTROL BUTTONS AND MICROPHONE
GUID-9DF2BF14-26E4-421F-8C28-693EF1EEDCE9
. Accept an incoming call by pushing display.
Instrument panel (if equipped): once. — : Signal strength indicator
. Redial the last outgoing call by pushing — : Battery status indicator*
the button for more than 2 seconds. — : Bluetooth® connection ON indica-
3. Phone end button tor
. Reject an incoming call by pushing the *: If low battery is indicated, the Blue-
tooth® device must be recharged soon.
button during an incoming call.
. End an active call by pushing the button . Up to 5 different Bluetooth® devices can be
once. connected. However, only one device can
be used at a time. If 5 different Bluetooth®
Microphone: devices are registered, a new device can
Microphone is located near the map lights. only replace one of the 5 existing paired
devices.
JVH0856X . The pairing procedure and operation may
vary according to device type and compat-
1. Phonebook quick search button ibility. See the Bluetooth® device Owner’s
Manual for further details.
capability of the registered device: When receiving an incoming call, the display on RejectingD23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
a call:
. : Cellular phone integration the audio unit will show the caller’s phone To reject an incoming call, select or by
number (or a notification message that the pushing on the steering wheel.
. : Audio streaming (A2DP – Advanced
caller’s phone number cannot be shown) and
Audio Distribution Profile)
three operation icons as illustrated. To high- Making a call
GUID-4E5C0ACE-B370-455F-A75D-533FE6C32DE3
Del. device:D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8 light different icons, turn the MENU/ENTER dial.
A registered device can be removed from Push the MENU/ENTER dial to select the high- WARNING:
Bluetooth® system registration. Select a regis- lighted icon.
tered device and push the MENU/ENTER dial to Park the vehicle in a safe location, and apply
Answering and during a call:
D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8 the parking brake before making a call.
confirm to deletion.
Answer the call by selecting on the display or
Bluetooth: D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8 by pushing on the steering wheel.
If Bluetooth® signal has been turned off, a During the call, the following icons are avail-
notification message “ON/OFF” appears when able:
you select “Bluetooth” from the phone menu. . :
(Push the button to display the phone
Select this item to end the call.
menu.) To turn the Bluetooth® signal on, push
the MENU/ENTER dial and a follow up screen . :
will appear. Select “ON” and push the MENU/ Select this item to put the call on hold.
ENTER dial to display the Bluetooth® settings . :
menu screen. Select this item to transfer the call from the
hands-free phone system to your cellular
USING THE GUID-D7C021DB-4A95-4462-830D-C2CDD9870B63
SYSTEM phone. JVH0863X
The hands-free mode can be operated using . :
the button on the instrument panel or A call can be initiated using one of the following
Select this item to transfer the call back to methods:
the button on the steering wheel. the hands-free phone system from the
cellular phone. . Making a call from the phonebook
Receiving a call
GUID-88F22BBE-2750-46B8-95C1-F31E7E701D42 . Manually dialing a phone number
. #123:
Select this item to enter numbers during a . Redialing
call. For example, use this function when . Using call history (Call List menu)
directed by an automated phone system to — Dialed
dial an extension number. — Received
Putting aD23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
call on hold: — Missed
To put a call on hold, select . Select to Making a call from the phonebook:
D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
return to the call. To reject the call select . Once the Bluetooth® connection has been
made between the registered cellular phone
and the hands-free phone system, phonebook
data will be transferred automatically to the
JVH0857X hands-free phone system. The transfer may
take a while before completion. Quick searching the phonebook: Manually dialing a phone number:
D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
NOTE:
Phone book data will be erased when:
. Switching to another registered cellular
phone.
. Cellular phone is disconnected.
. The registered cellular phone is deleted
from the audio system.
1. Push the button on instrument
panel or the button on the steering
wheel.
JVH0858X JVH0859X
2. Turn the MENU/ENTER dial to highlight
“Phone Book” and push the MENU/ENTER The quick search mode can be used as follows: To dial a phone number manually, perform the
dial. following operation:
1. Push the A-Z button.
3. Scroll down through the list, select the 1. Push the button on the instrument
2. Turn the MENU/ENTER dial for the first
appropriate contact name (highlighted), panel or the button on the steering
alphabetic or numerical letter of the con-
and push the MENU/ENTER dial. wheel and turn the MENU/ENTER dial to
tact name. Once highlighted, push the
4. The screen will show the number to be MENU/ENTER dial to select the letter. highlight “Dial Number”.
dialed. Push the MENU/ENTER dial to dial 2. Push the MENU/ENTER dial to select “Dial
3. The display will show the corresponding
the number. Number”.
contact name(s). Where necessary, use the
If more than one number is registered, MENU/ENTER dial to scroll further for the 3. Turn the MENU/ENTER dial to scroll along
select an appropriate icon. appropriate contact name to call. and highlight each number of the phone
. : Home number. Push the MENU/ENTER dial to
4. The screen will show the number to be
. : Cellular phone dialed. Push the MENU/ENTER dial to dial select the highlighted number.
. : Office the number. To delete the last number entered, scroll to
the “/” (Backspace symbol) and once high-
lighted, push the MENU/ENTER dial. The last
number will be deleted. Pushing the MENU/
ENTER dial repeatedly will delete each
subsequent number.
4. After entering the last number, highlight
the icon and push the MENU/ENTER
dial to dial the number.
. Missed
Redial: D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8 Ending a callGUID-FC22AEF1-3A90-4332-99D6-252EF04256E8
To redial or call the last number dialed, push Use the missed call mode to make a call To end an active call, highlight the icon
and hold the button on the instrument which is based on the list of missed calls. and push the ENTER/MENU dial or push the
panel or the button on the steering wheel 3. Scroll to the preferred phone number and button on the steering wheel.
for more than 2 seconds. push the MENU/ENTER dial, the
button on the instrument panel or the GENERAL SETTINGS
Using call history (Call list menu):
D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
GUID-D58E0F36-F995-40FC-936B-C4764B014FED
button on the steering wheel.
JVH0862X
JVH0860X
Using the MENU/ENTER dial, highlight “Settings”
A number from the dialed, received, or missed from the phone menu and push the MENU/
call lists can also be used to make a call. JVH0861X
ENTER dial.
1. Push the button on the instrument Whenever there is a second incoming call is Volume settings and manually downloading
panel or the button on the steering shown in the display. By selecting the icon the phonebook can be done using this menu.
wheel and select “Call List” on the display. the call is accepted and the current call is put
Menu operation:
2. Turn the MENU/ENTER dial and scroll to an on hold.
item, and push the MENU/ENTER dial to Turn the MENU/ENTER dial to change the
Selecting the icon using the MENU/ENTER
select an item. highlighted item and to change the volume
dial rejects the second incoming call. When this
settings.
Available items: is done during the conversation it ends the call.
. Dialed Push the MENU/ENTER dial to select the high-
Selecting the icon using the MENU/ENTER
lighted item and to apply the setting.
Use the dialed call mode to make a call dial switches the call on line between the first
which is based on the list of outgoing and the second call. Menu items:
(dialed) calls. . Volume
. Received — Ring
Set the phone ringing volume.
Use the received call mode to make a call
which is based on the list of received — Call
calls. Set the volume of the conversation
during a call.
. Immediately after the ignition switch is — Number of Channel: 79 1. Volume control -/ + buttons
placed in the “ON” position, it may be — This wireless equipment cannot be used Push the buttons to increase or decrease
impossible to receive a call for a short for any services related to safety due to the volume of the speakers.
period of time. the possibility of radio interference.
2. Phone send button
. Do not place the cellular phone in an area
surrounded by metal or far away from the REGULATORY INFORMATION
D23A131129-6C23BB4C-C105-47E8-B9AC-750A62A2F429
Push the button to initiate a phone
in-vehicle phone module to prevent tone session or answer an incoming call.
quality degradation and wireless connec- CE statement
D23A131129-7A19111C-3AD9-4477-B22C-D3BCD02029C7 3. Phone end button
tion disruption. Hereby “Yangfeng Visteon Automotive Electro-
nics Co., Ltd.” declares that this Bluetooth car Push the button to end a phone call or
. While a cellular phone is connected to stop the system from providing voice
through the Bluetooth® wireless connec- kit is in compliance with the essential require-
ments and other relevant provisions of Direc- prompts.
tion, the battery power of the cellular
phone may discharge quicker than usual. tive 1999/5/EC. Microphone:
. If the Bluetooth® Hands-Free Phone System Microphone is located near the map lights.
seems to be malfunctioning, please contact The NISSAN Voice Recognition system (if
a NISSAN dealer. NSY0105 equipped) allows hands-free operation of the
. Some cellular phones or other devices may Bluetooth® Hands- Free Phone System.
cause interference or a buzzing noise to Bluetooth® D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
Trademark: If the vehicle is in motion, some commands
come from the audio system speakers. may not be available so full attention may be
Bluetooth® is a trademark
Storing the device in a different location given to vehicle operation.
owned by Bluetooth SIG, Inc.
may reduce or eliminate the noise.
and licensed to Visteon Cor-
. Refer to the cellular phone Owner’s Manual poration. Setup D23A131129-B8B13EEC-55D2-4607-8E58-86805992FB91
regarding the telephone pairing procedure
specific to your phone, battery charging, USING THE SYSTEM Choosing aD23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
language:
D23A131129-FC621B22-3BE5-4BA1-BF5D-4F33C6257DCC
cellular phone antenna, etc. Control buttons: You can interact with the Bluetooth® Hands-
. The antenna display on the monitor will not Free Phone System using several languages
coincide with the antenna display of some that are available. To change the language,
cellular phones. perform the following. See “Audio main opera-
. Keep the interior of the vehicle as quiet as tion” (P.4-58) or “Audio main operation” (P.4-64).
possible to hear the caller’s voice clearly as ConnectingD23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
procedure:
well as to minimize its echoes. You can register up to 5 different Bluetooth®
. If reception between callers is unclear, cellular phones in the in-vehicle phone module.
adjusting the incoming or outgoing call However, you can talk on only one cellular
volume may improve the clarity. phone at a time.
. This wireless hands free car kit is based on To connect a phone to the Bluetooth® hands-
Bluetooth® technology. free phone system. See “Connecting Bluetooth®
— Frequency: 2402 MHz - 2480 MHz JVH0855X device” (P.4-62) or “Connecting Bluetooth®
— Modulation: FHSS GFSK 8DPSK, π/ device” (P.4-68).
4DQPSK
Selecting aD23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
registered phone: Phone menuGUID-8FE8E0A0-1871-49A6-90C3-3A2803629027 Push the button on the steering wheel
1. Push the ENTER/SETTING button. to move through the list and select the
Push the button to bring up the phone
person you wish to call.
2. Use the TUNE·FOLDER dial to select “Blue- menu. The available options are:
. Delete Entry
tooth” and then push the ENTER/SETTING . Call
button. Select this item to delete an entry in the
. Phonebook phonebook. Choose an entry to delete.
3. Select “Select Phone”, and then push the . Record Name (if equipped)
ENTER/SETTING button. . Recent Calls Record Name (if equipped):
D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
4. Select the phone you wish to use. . Select Phone The system allows you to record custom voice
tags for contact names in the phonebook. Up
Deleting a registered phone:
D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8 Call: to 40 voice tags can be recorded to the system.
D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
1. Push the ENTER/SETTING button. The following items are available under “Call”. Recent Calls:D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
2. Use the TUNE·FOLDER dial to select “Blue- . List Names The following items are available under “Recent
tooth” and then push the ENTER/SETTING Select this item to have the system list the Calls”:
button. names in the phonebook one by one in
. Incoming Calls
3. Select “Delete Phone”, and then push the alphabetical order. Select “Dial” to dial the
ENTER/SETTING button. number of the currently selected name. Select this item to list the last five incoming
Push the button on the steering wheel calls to the vehicle. If the call is from an
4. Use the TUNE·FOLDER dial to select the entry in the phonebook, the name will be
phone you wish to delete. to move through the list and select the
person you wish to call. displayed. Otherwise, the phone number of
NOTE: the incoming call will be displayed.
. Redial
Select “Dial” to call the number. Select “Next
When you delete a phone, the associated Select this item to call the last number
Entry” or “Previous Entry” to move through
phonebook for the phone will also be de- dialed.
the list of incoming calls.
leted. . Call Back
. Missed Calls
Bluetooth® D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
on/off: Select this item to call the number of the
Select this item to list the last five missed
1. Push the ENTER/SETTING button. last incoming call to the vehicle.
calls to the vehicle. If the call is from an
2. Use the TUNE·FOLDER dial to select “Blue- Phonebook:D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8 entry in the phonebook, the name will be
tooth” and then push the ENTER/SETTING The following items are available under “Phone- displayed. Otherwise, the phone number of
button. book”. the missed call will be displayed. Select
3. Select “Bluetooth” and select “On” or “Off” to “Dial” to call the number. Select “Next Entry”
turn the vehicle’s Bluetooth® system on or NOTE: or “Previous Entry” to move through the list
off. Each phone has its own separate phonebook. of missed calls.
You cannot access Phone A’s phonebook if . Outgoing Calls
When Bluetooth® is off, you will not be able to
make or receive calls by the hands-free mode. you are currently connected with Phone B. Select this item to list the last five outgoing
Also, you will not have access to the phone- . List Names calls from the vehicle. If the call was to an
book. entry in the phonebook, the name will be
Select this item to have the system list the displayed. Otherwise, the phone number of
names in the phonebook one by one in the outgoing call will be displayed. Select
alphabetical order. Select “Dial” to dial the “Dial” to call the number. Select “Next Entry”
number of the currently selected name.
Monitor, air conditioner, audio and phone system 4-85
RECEIVING AGUID-37F38EE2-29EC-4431-A7A1-4BFA73006A79
CALL Bluetooth® SETTINGS . Download Phonebook Now:
GUID-7F866DB0-23D6-4EDE-8E81-FBF617C720C4
When a call is placed to the connected phone, To access the Bluetooth® settings screen: Select to download the phonebook to the
the display will change to phone mode. vehicle from the chosen source.
1. Push the SETUP button.
. Phone Notifications for:
To accept the incoming call, take one of the 2. Touch the “Telephone & Bluetooth” key.
following actions. Select “Driver” to have phone notifications
Available setting items: shown in the vehicle information display.
. Push the button on the steering wheel. Select “Both” to have phone notifications
. Telephone Setup
. Touch the “ ” icon on the screen. shown in both the vehicle information
See “Telephone setup” (P.4-89) for details.
To reject the incoming call, take one of the display and the display.
following actions. . Pair New Device
Select to pair a new Bluetooth® device to
. Push the button on the steering wheel.
the Bluetooth® Hands-Free Phone System.
. Touch the red phone “ ” icon on the
. Select Paired Device
screen.
Select to choose a Bluetooth® device from
DURING A CALL a list of those devices paired to the Blue-
GUID-F0780943-E7D8-41D2-948B-26D6171704CD
tooth® Hands-Free Phone System.
While a call is active, the following options are
available on the screen: . Delete Paired Device
Select to delete a Bluetooth® device from a
. “Handset”
list of those devices connected/paired to
Select this option to switch control of the the Bluetooth® Hands-Free Phone System.
phone call over to the handset.
. Bluetooth
. “Mute Mic.”
Select to toggle Bluetooth® on and off.
Select this option to mute the microphone.
Select again to unmute the microphone. TELEPHONE GUID-614A2469-6381-4164-B6C9-90D2B44BAC8F
SETUP
. “ ” icon To access the phone settings screen:
Select to end the phone call.
1. Push the SETUP button.
ENDING A CALL
GUID-1E95D871-8BE9-4857-8794-BA6B4DC851A7
2. Touch the “Telephone & Bluetooth” key.
To end a phone call, select the “ ” icon on 3. Touch the “Telephone Setup” key.
the screen or push the button on the Available setting items:
steering wheel.
. Sort Phonebook By:
Select “First Name” or “Last Name” to
choose how phonebook entries are alpha-
betically displayed on the screen.
. Phonebook:
Select “Phone” to use the handset’s phone-
book. Select “SIM” to use the phonebook on
the SIM card. Select “Both” to use both
sources.
Monitor, air conditioner, audio and phone system 4-89
MEMO
Trailer towing (except for Australia, New Zealand, South Brake system ...............................................................................................
.... 5-35
Africa and Latin America) ....................................................................
.... 5-32 Brake precautions ..........................................................................
.... 5-35
Trailer towing (for Australia, New Zealand, South Africa and Brake assist (if equipped) .........................................................
.... 5-35
Latin America) ..............................................................................................
.... 5-33 Anti-lock Braking System (ABS) (if equipped) ........... .... 5-35
Operating precautions ...................................................................
.... 5-33 Vehicle security ..........................................................................................
.... 5-36
Maximum load limits (for Australia and Cold weather driving .............................................................................
.... 5-37
New Zealand) .........................................................................................
.... 5-33
Battery .....................................................................................................
.... 5-37
Tire pressure ..........................................................................................
.... 5-34
Engine coolant ..................................................................................
.... 5-37
Safety chains .........................................................................................
.... 5-34
Tire equipment ..................................................................................
.... 5-37
Trailer brakes .........................................................................................
.... 5-34
Special winter equipment ........................................................
.... 5-37
Trailer detection (if equipped) .................................................
.... 5-34
Parking brake .....................................................................................
.... 5-37
Power steering .............................................................................................
.... 5-34
Corrosion protection ....................................................................
.... 5-38
EXHAUSTD23A131129-5F1AD384-CD8D-48F8-9A11-E6AB3746A2F9
GAS (carbon monoxide) — You notice a change in the sound of inspected promptly by a NISSAN dealer.
the exhaust system. . Avoid driving with an extremely low fuel
WARNING: — You have had an accident involving level. Running out of fuel could cause the
damage to the exhaust system, un- engine to misfire, damaging the three-
. Do not breathe exhaust gas; it contains derbody, or rear of the vehicle. way catalyst.
colorless and odorless carbon monoxide.
Carbon monoxide is dangerous. It can . Do not race the engine while warming it
cause unconsciousness or death.
THREE-WAY CATALYST (if equipped)
GUID-2A947513-B690-48C8-BB3E-561794A32491 up.
. If you suspect that exhaust fumes are . Do not push or tow your vehicle to start
WARNING: the engine.
entering the vehicle, drive with all win-
dows fully open, and have the vehicle . The exhaust gas and the exhaust system
inspected immediately. are very hot. Keep people, animals and
. Do not run the engine in closed spaces flammable materials away from the ex-
such as a garage. haust system components.
. Do not park the vehicle with the engine . Do not stop or park the vehicle over
running for an extended period of time. flammable materials such as dry grass,
wastepaper or rags. They may ignite and
. If electrical wiring or other cable connec- cause a fire.
tions must pass to a trailer through the
seal of the body, follow the manufac- The three-way catalyst is an emission control
turer’s recommendations to prevent car- device installed in the exhaust system. Exhaust
bon monoxide entry into the vehicle. gas in the three-way catalyst is burned at high
temperatures to help reduce pollutants.
. If a special body or other equipment is
added for recreational or other usage,
follow the manufacturer’s recommenda- CAUTION:
tion to prevent carbon monoxide entry . Do not use leaded gasoline. (See “Recom-
into the vehicle. (Some recreational vehi- mended fluids/lubricants and capacities”
cle appliances such as stoves, refrigera- (P.9-2).) Deposits from leaded gasoline
tors, heaters, etc. may also generate seriously reduce the ability of the three-
carbon monoxide.) way catalyst to help reduce exhaust
. The exhaust system and body should be pollutants and/or damage the three-
inspected by a qualified mechanic when- way catalyst.
ever: . Keep your engine tuned up. Malfunctions
— Your vehicle is raised while being in the ignition, fuel injection, or electrical
serviced. systems may cause overrich fuel to flow
— You suspect that exhaust fumes are into the three-way catalyst, causing it to
entering into the passenger compart- overheat. Do not keep driving if the
ment. engine misfires, or if noticeable loss of
performance or other unusual operating
conditions are detected. Have the vehicle
indicate a system malfunction. 1. Park the vehicle safely off the road, away Interrupting the manual regeneration
. The manual regeneration will not work from traffic and in an open area. process GUID-BD2FCE3E-33A3-462D-8752-DB5449A36C09
when the engine, the coolant tempera- Do not park the vehicle over flammable Perform any one of the following methods to
ture and ambient temperature are cold. It materials. interrupt the process (if necessary):
starts only after the engine has warmed
2. Apply the parking brake. . Depress the accelerator pedal or brake
up.
. If the DPF regeneration switch indicator 3. Move the shift lever to the “P” (Park) pedal.
light does not blink even after the engine position (Automatic transmission model) . Depress the clutch pedal (Manual transmis-
has warmed up and DPF warning light or the “N” (Neutral) position (Manual trans- sion model).
turns on, this may indicate a system mission model). . Push and hold the DPF regeneration switch
malfunction. Have your vehicle checked DO NOT STOP THE ENGINE. for about three seconds (indicator light
at a NISSAN dealer. 4. Push the DPF regeneration switch to start turns off).
. During the regeneration process, the the regeneration process. The engine
engine speed will increase first up to NOTE:
speed will automatically increase. . When interrupting the manual regenera-
3,000 rpm (during warm up of the en-
gine) and then drop to 1,700 rpm. This (The indicator light of the DPF regeneration tion process, the DPF warning light may
engine speed will be kept until regenera- switch will turn on.) illuminate and the DPF regeneration
tion process is completed. 5. The filter regeneration process is com- switch indicator light may blink. If this
pleted when the DPF warning light in the happens, perform the regeneration pro-
The regeneration process will take ap- instrument panel and the indicator light of cess again.
proximately 45 minutes. In some cases, the DPF regeneration switch turn off. . If the DPF regeneration switch indicator
time to completion may vary. light continues to blink with the DPF
CAUTION: warning light on, even after the regen-
eration process has been performed
If any of the following symptoms are en- three consecutive times, this may indi-
countered, have your vehicle checked at a cate a system malfunction. Have your
NISSAN dealer. vehicle checked at a NISSAN dealer.
. The DPF warning light does not turn off . If the DPF regeneration switch indicator
and the DPF regeneration switch indica- light does not illuminate even after the
tor light blinks again even after the switch with the indicator light blinking is
regeneration process has been per- pressed, turn the ignition switch OFF and
formed three consecutive times. wait for approximately 3 minutes. Then
turn the ignition switch back to the ON
. A large amount of black smoke is emitted position and perform the process again
JVS0935X from the muffler of your vehicle. from step 4.
If the DPF warning light illuminates and the
indicator light of the DPF regeneration switch
blinks:
SSD0392
AUTOMATIC GUID-98BF8A48-751F-4E30-9600-72034BC1A457
TRANSMISSION (AT) STEERING LOCK
D23A131129-D6FE7781-3CD1-4109-BCCF-7B07BDC85D58
IGNITIOND23A131129-434A2803-2481-44B2-BC6D-2A5654A3D2A6
SWITCH POSITIONS
The ignition lock is designed so that the The ignition switch is equipped with an anti-
ignition switch cannot be switched to the theft steering lock device. WARNING:
“LOCK” position until the shift lever is moved
To lock steering wheel Never place the ignition switch in the “OFF”
to the “P” (Park) position. When pushing the D23A131129-86F5BC35-AB03-42A7-9984-E61D3BA4F30F position while driving. The steering wheel
ignition switch to the “OFF” position, make sure 1. Place the ignition switch in the “OFF” may lock and cause the driver to lose control
the shift lever is in the “P” (Park) position. position where the ignition switch position of the vehicle, resulting in serious vehicle
When the ignition switch cannot be switched to indicator will not illuminate. damage or personal injury.
the “LOCK” position: 2. Open or close the door. The ignition switch
1. “Shift to Park” warning appears on the turns to the “LOCK” position.
CAUTION:
vehicle information display and a chime 3. Turn the steering wheel 1/6 of a turn to the
sounds. right or left from the straight up position. . Do not leave the vehicle for extended
2. Move the shift lever to the “P” (Park) periods of time when the ignition switch
position. To unlock steering wheel
D23A131129-AF0EE9A1-8CD4-4CA0-8E81-1C1EC2D70C67
is in the “ON” position and the engine is
Push the ignition switch, and the steering not running. This can discharge the
3. If the ignition switch is in the “ACC” position, battery.
PUSH warning appears on the vehicle wheel will be automatically unlocked.
information display. . Use electrical accessories with the engine
CAUTION: running to avoid discharging the vehicle
4. Push the ignition switch. The ignition battery. If you must use accessories while
switch is switched to the “OFF” position. . If the battery of the vehicle is discharged, the engine is not running, do not use
5. Open the door. The ignition switch turns to the push-button ignition switch cannot them for extended periods of time and do
the “LOCK” position. be switched from the “LOCK” position. not use multiple electrical accessories at
For warnings and indicators on the vehicle . If the steering lock release malfunction the same time.
information display, see “Vehicle information indicator (if equipped) appears in the
display (models with color display)” (P.2-20). vehicle information display, push the
ignition switch again while rotating the
If the ignition switch is switched to the “LOCK” steering wheel slightly to the right and
position, the shift lever cannot be moved from left. (See “Vehicle information display
the “P” (Park) position. The shift lever can be (models with color display)” (P.2-20).)
moved if the ignition switch is in the “ON”
position with the foot brake pedal depressed.
JVS0241X
transmission model), the ignition switch posi- INTELLIGENT KEY BATTERY DISCHARGE NOTE:
D23A131129-6AD12075-0F90-482B-A8A9-5D798ABAEF36
tion will change as follows: . When the ignition switch is pushed to the
. Push once to change to “ACC”. “ACC” or “ON” position or the engine is
started by the above procedures, the Key
. Push two times to change to “ON”.
Battery low warning appears on the
. Push three times to change to “OFF”. vehicle information display even if the
. Push four times to return to “ACC”. Intelligent Key is inside the vehicle. This is
. Open or close any door to return to “LOCK” not a malfunction. To turn off the warn-
from the “OFF” position. ing, touch the ignition switch with the
Intelligent Key again.
LOCK position
D23A131129-13EAC4B8-294C-43EE-80EB-860DF692C223 . If the Key Battery low warning appears
The ignition switch and steering lock can only on the vehicle information display, re-
be locked at this position. place the battery as soon as possible.
SSD0944 (See “Battery” (P.8-21).)
The ignition switch will be unlocked when it is
pushed to the “ACC” position while carrying the If the battery of the Intelligent Key is dis-
Intelligent Key. charged, or environmental conditions interfere
with the Intelligent Key operation, start the
ACC position
D23A131129-5EE40441-19D8-4364-98EF-D70EDE9B72D6 engine according to the following procedure:
The electrical accessory power activates at this 1. Automatic Transmission (AT) model:
position without the engine turned on.
Move the shift lever to the “P” (Park)
ON position
D23A131129-C0122229-99D6-4DB9-A50D-49E0BF5D52BC
position.
The ignition system and the electrical acces- Manual Transmission (MT) model:
sory power activate at this position without the Move the shift lever to the “N” (Neutral)
engine turned on. position.
OFF position 2. Firmly depress the brake pedal.
D23A131129-F10989AD-05BB-41F0-B3D5-C4B4D65F5079
The engine is turned off with the steering wheel 3. Touch the ignition switch with the Intelli-
unlocked. gent Key as illustrated. (A chime will sound.)
4. Push the ignition switch while depressing
the brake pedal (AT model) or the clutch
pedal (MT model) within 10 seconds after
the chime sounds. The engine will start.
After step 3 is performed, when the ignition
switch is pushed without depressing the brake
pedal (AT model) or the clutch pedal (MT
model), the ignition switch position will change
to “ACC”.
DRIVING VEHICLE
D23A131129-E7D545DD-C9D2-4F21-94C5-693AFF273F14
. Shift into the “P” (Park) position and apply
CAUTION: DRIVING WITH AUTOMATIC TRANSMIS- the parking brake when at a standstill for
. As soon as the engine has started, SION (AT)D23A131129-D53AADA2-7E82-438E-A9C6-73261C06D641 longer than a short waiting period.
release the ignition switch immediately. The Automatic Transmission (AT) in your vehi- . Keep the engine at idling speed while
. Do not operate the starter for more than cle is electronically controlled to produce max- shifting from the “N” (Neutral) position to
15 seconds at a time. If the engine does imum power and smooth operation. any driving position.
not start, push the ignition switch to the The recommended operating procedures for . When stopping the vehicle on an uphill
“OFF” position and wait 20 seconds be- this transmission are shown on the following grade, do not hold the vehicle by depres-
fore cranking the engine again. Other- pages. Follow these procedures for maximum sing the accelerator pedal. The foot brake
wise, the starter could be damaged. vehicle performance and driving enjoyment. pedal should be depressed in this situa-
. If it becomes necessary to start the tion.
engine with a booster battery and jumper CAUTION:
cables, the instructions and cautions Starting D23A131129-5203B09F-C87E-4EBF-9EF8-75C2FCD83BD7
vehicle
. The cold engine idle speed is high, so use
contained in the “6. In case of emergency” caution when shifting into a forward or 1. After starting the engine, fully depress the
section should be carefully followed. reverse gear before the engine has foot brake pedal before attempting to
warmed up. move the shift lever out of the “P” (Park)
5. Allow the engine to idle for at least 30 position.
seconds after starting the engine to warm- . Avoid revving up the engine while the
up. Drive at moderate speeds for a short vehicle is stopped. This could cause un- 2. Keep the foot brake pedal depressed and
distance first, especially in cold weather. expected vehicle movement. move the shift lever into a driving position.
. Do not downshift abruptly on slippery 3. Release the parking brake, the foot brake
CAUTION: roads. This may cause a loss of control. pedal, and then gradually start the vehicle
in motion.
Do not leave the vehicle unattended while . Never shift to either the “P” (Park) or “R”
(Reverse) position while the vehicle is The AT is designed so the foot brake pedal
the engine is warming up. MUST be depressed before shifting from the
moving forward and “P” (Park) or “D”
6. To stop the engine, move the shift lever to (Drive) position while the vehicle is mov- “P” (Park) position to any driving position
the “P” (Park) (AT model) or “N” (Neutral) (MT ing rearward. This could cause an acci- while the ignition switch is in the “ON”
model) position, apply the parking brake, dent or damage the transmission. position.
and push the ignition switch to the “OFF” . Except in an emergency, do not shift to The shift lever cannot be moved out of the
position. the “N” (Neutral) position while driving. “P” (Park) position and into any of the other
Coasting with the transmission in the “N” gear positions if the ignition switch is placed
(Neutral) position may cause serious da- in the “LOCK”, “OFF” or “ACC” position.
mage to the transmission.
. Start the engine in either the “P” (Park) or CAUTION:
“N” (Neutral) position. The engine will not . DEPRESS THE FOOT BRAKE PEDAL - Shift-
start in any other gear position. If it does, ing the shift lever to “D”, “R” or manual
have your vehicle checked by a NISSAN shift mode without depressing the foot
dealer. brake pedal causes the vehicle to move
slowly when the engine is running. Make
sure the foot brake pedal is depressed : Push the button while depressing P (Park): D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
fully and the vehicle is stopped before the brake pedal Use this position when the vehicle is parked or
shifting the shift lever. : Push the button when starting the engine. Make sure that the
. MAKE SURE OF THE SHIFT LEVER POSI- : Just move the shift lever vehicle is completely stopped and move the
TION - Make sure the shift lever is in the shift lever into the “P” (Park) position. Apply
desired position. “D” and manual shift the parking brake. When parking on a hill, first
mode are used to move forward and “R” WARNING: depress the foot brake pedal, apply the parking
to back up. Depress the accelerator pedal brake, and then move the shift lever into the “P”
to start the vehicle and merge with traffic . Apply the parking brake if the shift lever (Park) position.
(avoid abrupt starting and spinning the is in any position while the engine is not
wheels). running. Failure to do so could cause the R (Reverse):D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
vehicle to move unexpectedly or roll Use this position to back up. Make sure that the
. WARM UP THE ENGINE - Due to the higher
away and result in serious personal injury vehicle is completely stopped before selecting
idle speeds when the engine is cold, extra
or property damage. the “R” (Reverse) position.
caution must be exercised when shifting
the shift lever into the driving position . If the shift lever cannot be moved from N (Neutral):D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
immediately after starting the engine. the “P” (Park) position while the engine is
running and the foot brake pedal is Neither the forward nor reverse gear is en-
. PARKING THE VEHICLE. gaged. The engine can be started in this
depressed, the stop lights may not work.
Malfunctioning stop lights could cause an position. You may shift to the “N” (Neutral)
Depress the foot brake pedal and, once position and restart a stalled engine while the
the vehicle stops, move the shift lever accident injuring yourself and others.
vehicle is moving.
into the “P” (Park) position, pull the After starting the engine, fully depress the foot
parking brake lever and release the foot brake pedal, push the shift lever button and D (Drive): D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
brake pedal. move the shift lever out of the “P” (Park) Use this position for all normal forward driving.
position.
Shifting D23A131129-9F637E0A-E3E2-4DA1-AFD5-A004185AD060
Manual shift mode
D23A131129-C44C5269-B111-4076-A731-A16FA94EA2DF
If the ignition switch is placed in the “OFF” or
“ACC” position for any reason while the shift When the shift lever is shifted to the manual
lever is in any positions other than the “P” (Park) shift gate and moved up or down while driving,
position, the ignition switch cannot be placed the transmission enters the manual shift mode.
in the “LOCK” position. Shift range can be selected manually.
If the ignition switch cannot be placed in the When shifting up, move the shift lever to the +
“LOCK” position, perform the following steps: (up) side. The transmission shifts to the higher
range.
1. Apply the parking brake.
When shifting down, move the shift lever to the
2. Place the ignition switch in the “ON” posi- − (down) side. The transmission shifts to the
tion while depressing the foot brake pedal. lower range.
3. Move the shift lever to the “P” (Park) When canceling the manual shift mode, return
JVS0443X position. the shift lever to the “D” (Drive) position. The
4. Place the ignition switch in the “LOCK” transmission returns to the normal driving
position. mode.
In the manual shift mode, the shift range is . When the transmission does not shift to 2. Apply the parking brake.
displayed in the vehicle information display the selected gear, the Automatic Trans- 3. Push down the shift lock release button .
between the speedometer and tachometer. mission (AT) position indicator light (in
the vehicle information display) will blink 4. Push and hold the shift lever button and
Shift ranges up or down one by one as follows: move the shift lever to the “N” (Neutral)
and the buzzer will sound.
? ? ? ? ? ? position while holding down the shift lock
M
1 M
2 M
3 M
4 M
5 M
6
M
7 . In the manual shift mode, the transmis-
/ / / / / / release button .
sion automatically shifts down to 1st gear
M before the vehicle comes to a stop. When Place the ignition switch in the “ON” position to
7 (7th):
accelerating again, it is necessary to shift release the steering wheel lock.
Use this position for all normal forward driving up to the desired range. The vehicle may be moved, by pushing, to the
at highway speeds.
desired location.
M
6 (6th) and M5 (5th): Accelerator downshift - in D (Drive)
If the shift lever cannot be moved out of the “P”
Use these positions when driving up long position D23A131129-DFCA6910-8FE6-42C8-9E08-0547E2580CC0
- (Park) position, have a NISSAN dealer check the
slopes, or for engine braking when driving For passing or climbing hills, depress the AT system as soon as possible.
down long slopes. accelerator pedal to the floor. This shifts the
M
4 (4th), M3 (3rd) and M2 (2nd): transmission down into a lower gear, depend- Fail-safe D23A131129-CE544870-295F-4C51-AD1F-3CB783F5DA1D
ing on the vehicle speed. When the fail-safe operation occurs, the AT will
Use these positions for hill climbing or engine
be locked in any of the forward gears depend-
braking on downhill grades. Shift lock release
D23A131129-D542B7A3-4228-4AFB-B367-04BEFAD75B94 ing on conditions.
M
1 (1st):
If the vehicle is driven under extreme condi-
Use this position when climbing steep hills tions, such as excessive wheel spinning and
slowly or driving slowly through deep snow, or subsequent hard braking, the fail-safe sys-
for maximum engine braking on steep downhill tem may be activated. This will occur even if
grades. all electrical circuits are functioning properly.
. Remember not to drive at high speeds for In this case, place the ignition switch in the
extended periods of time in lower than 7th “OFF” position and wait for 3 seconds. Then
gear. This reduces fuel economy. place the ignition switch back in the “ON”
. Moving the shift lever to the same side position. The vehicle should return to its
twice will shift the ranges in succession. normal operating condition. If it does not
However, if this motion is rapidly done, the return to its normal operating condition,
second shifting may not be completed JVS0444X have a NISSAN dealer check the transmission
properly. and repair it if necessary.
If the battery is discharged, the shift lever may
. In the manual shift mode, the transmis- not be moved from the “P” (Park) position even
sion may not shift to the selected gear or with the brake pedal depressed.
may automatically shift to the other gear.
This helps maintain driving performance To release the shift lock, perform the following
and reduces the chance of vehicle da- procedure:
mage or loss of control. 1. Place the ignition switch in the “OFF” or
“LOCK” position.
JVS0445X
4WD mode switch
To change into or out of 4LO mode: is approximately 50 km/h (30 MPH). If the vehicleGUID-645DF063-2BC8-4CC4-847C-31E61CC5A750
gets stuck
1. The vehicle MUST BE standing still. . The 4WD mode switch can be turned . Place stones or wooden blocks under the
2. Depress the clutch pedal (MT model) and between 2WD and 4H while driving tires to free the vehicle.
the brake pedal and move the shift lever to straight ahead. Do not turn the 4WD . Set the 4WD mode switch to 4H or 4LO.
N (Neutral). mode switch while making a turn or
. If it is difficult to free the vehicle, drive the
reversing.
3. Depress and turn the 4WD mode switch to vehicle forwards and backwards to in-
change into or out of 4LO. . Do not turn the 4WD mode switch be- crease the momentum. If the vehicle is
tween 2WD and 4H while driving on steep stuck deep in mud, tire chains may be
downhill grades. Use the engine brake effective.
WARNING: and low transmission gears for engine
. When parking, apply the parking brake braking. CAUTION:
before stopping the engine and make . Do not turn the 4WD mode switch be-
sure that the 4WD mode indicator is on tween 2WD and 4H with the rear wheels . Do not spin the wheels excessively. The
and that the ATP warning light or ATP spinning. wheels will sink deep into the mud and it
warning message is off, otherwise, the will be difficult to free the vehicle from
. Do not drive the vehicle in 4H or 4LO the mud.
vehicle could unexpectedly move even if
mode on dry, hard surfaced roads. This
the automatic transmission is in the P . Avoid shifting gears with the engine
may cause unnecessary noise and tire
(Park) position. running at high speeds as this may cause
wear. NISSAN recommends driving in
. The 4LO indicator must stop blinking and 2WD under these conditions. a malfunction.
remain on or turn off before shifting the
. It is not possible to shift the 4WD transfer 4WD MODE SWITCH OPERATION
transmission into gear. The vehicle may
case between 4H and 4LO at low ambient D23A131129-520BF100-A44E-44AC-B57F-91A162E58E30
move unexpectedly if the shift lever is
temperatures when the engine is cold.
shifted from the N (Neutral) position to
Doing so may cause the 4LO indicator to
any other gear while the 4LO indicator is
blink. Wait until the 4WD transfer case
blinking.
has reached operational temperature
(after driving for a while) before using
CAUTION: the 4WD mode switch to change between
4H and 4LO.
. Never turn the 4WD mode switch be-
tween 4LO and 4H while driving.
When drivingGUID-BA867A25-E388-4139-85A2-B6778A15CB2F
on rough roads
. The 4H drive mode provides greater
. Set the 4WD mode switch to 4H or 4LO.
power and traction. Avoid excessive
speed as it will cause increased fuel . Drive carefully and according to the road
JVS0445X
consumption and higher oil tempera- surface conditions.
tures, and could damage power train . Set the 4WD mode switch to 2WD, 4H or
components. Speeds over 100 km/h (60 4LO, depending on driving conditions.
MPH) in 4H are not recommended. . You may feel a slight vehicle movement if
. The 4LO drive mode provides maximum the 4WD mode switch is operated while
power and traction. Avoid raising vehicle making a turn, accelerating or decelerating,
speed excessively. The maximum speed or if the ignition switch is placed in the
“OFF” position while the 4WD mode switch While the engine is running, the 4WD mode
is set to 4H or 4LO. This is normal. indicator will illuminate the position selected by CAUTION:
the 4WD mode switch. . If the 4WD warning light comes on or
CAUTION: . The 4WD mode indicator may blink while blinks during operation for a while, have
shifting from one drive mode to the your vehicle checked by a NISSAN dealer
. The 4WD mode switch can be turned as soon as possible.
other. When the shifting is completed,
between 2WD and 4H while driving
the 4WD mode indicator will come on. If . Shifting between 4H and 4LO is not
straight ahead. Do not turn the 4WD
the indicator does not come on immedi- recommended when the 4WD warning
mode switch while making a turn or
ately, make sure the area around the light turns on.
reversing.
vehicle is safe, and drive the vehicle
. Do not operate the 4WD mode switch straight, accelerate or decelerate or move . When the 4WD warning light comes on,
while driving on steep downhill grades. the vehicle in reverse, then shift the 4WD the 2WD mode may be engaged even if
Use the engine brake by setting a low mode switch. the 4WD mode switch is in 4H. Be
transmission gear. especially careful when driving. If corre-
. If the 4WD warning light comes on or 4WD sponding parts are malfunctioning, the
. Do not operate the 4WD mode switch Error warning (if equipped) appears, the 4WD mode will not be engaged even if
with the rear wheels spinning. 4WD mode indicator turns off. the 4WD mode switch is shifted.
. Before turning the 4WD mode switch to
4H from 2WD, make sure that the vehicle
4WD WARNING
D23A131129-756BD005-A93B-49B9-968A-C3FB16BBA51A
. Do not drive the vehicle in the 4H or 4LO
position on dry hard surface roads. Driv-
speed is less than 100 km/h (60 MPH). Warning light ing on dry, hard surfaces in 4H or 4LO
Failure to do so can damage the 4WD GUID-662D7D70-077C-4129-9623-D9A52BBB3DC4
may cause unnecessary noise, tire wear
system. Comes on or and increased fuel consumption.
Warning light blinks when:
. Never turn the 4WD mode switch be-
tween 4LO and 4H while driving. There is a mal- If the Four-Wheel Drive (4WD) warning
Illuminates function in the light turns on when driving on dry hard
4WD MODE INDICATOR 4WD system surface roads:
D23A131129-80CA9BD9-C099-4DDB-A298-95998425794D
The difference — in the 4H position, shift the 4WD mode
Blinks in wheel rota- switch to 2WD.
tion is large — in the 4LO position, stop the vehicle
and shift the transmission lever to
If the 4WD warning light comes on, the 4WD the “N” (Neutral) position with the
mode indicator turns off. brake pedal depressed and shift the
A large difference between the diameters of 4WD mode switch to 2WD.
front and rear wheels will make the 4WD
warning light blink. Change the 4WD mode If the 4WD warning light is still on after
switch to 2WD and do not drive fast. the above operation, have your vehicle
checked by a NISSAN dealer as soon as
possible.
JVS0447X
. The transfer case may be damaged if you
The 4WD mode indicator is displayed in the continue driving with the warning light
vehicle information display.
Starting and driving 5-21
VDC warning light may illuminate. . The road may be slippery or the system VEHICLE DYNAMIC CONTROL (VDC) OFF
This is not a malfunction. Restart the may determine some action is required to SWITCH D23A131129-C40ADF15-B0E4-4B5A-BCFA-C6FC4EB114B7
engine after driving onto a stable surface. help the vehicle on the steered path.
. If wheels or tires other than the NISSAN . You may feel a pulsation in the brake pedal
recommended ones are used, the VDC and hear a noise or vibration from under
system may not operate properly and the the hood. This is normal and indicates that
VDC warning light may illuminate. the VDC system is working properly.
. The VDC system is not a substitute for . Adjust your speed and driving to the road
winter tires or tire chains on a snow conditions.
covered road. If a malfunction occurs in the system, the VDC
warning light illuminates in the instrument
The Vehicle Dynamic Control (VDC) system panel. The VDC system automatically turns off.
uses various sensors to monitor driver inputs
and vehicle motion. Under certain driving con- The VDC OFF switch is used to turn off the VDC
ditions, the VDC system helps to perform the system. The VDC off indicator light illumi- SSD1149
following functions. nates to indicate the VDC system is off. When
the VDC OFF switch is used to turn off the The vehicle should be driven with the Vehicle
. Controls brake pressure to reduce wheel system, the VDC system still operates to pre- Dynamic Control (VDC) system ON for most
slip on one slipping drive wheel so power is vent one drive wheel from slipping by transfer- driving conditions.
transferred to a non slipping drive wheel on ring power to a non slipping drive wheel. The
the same axle. When the vehicle is stuck in mud or snow, the
VDC warning light flashes if this occurs. All VDC system reduces the engine output to
. Controls brake pressure and engine output other VDC functions are off and the VDC reduce wheel spin. The engine speed will be
to reduce drive wheel slip based on vehicle warning light will not flash. The VDC reduced even if the accelerator is depressed to
speed (traction control function). system is automatically reset to on when the the floor. If maximum engine power is needed
. Controls brake pressure at individual ignition switch is placed in the “OFF” position to free a stuck vehicle, turn the VDC system off.
wheels and engine output to help the driver then back to the “ON” position.
maintain control of the vehicle in the To turn off the Vehicle Dynamic Control (VDC)
When the 4LO position is selected with the system, push the VDC OFF switch. The VDC off
following conditions: Four-Wheel Drive (4WD) mode switch, the VDC indicator light will illuminate.
— understeer (vehicle tends to not follow system is disabled and the VDC off indicator
the steered path despite increased light illuminates. Push the VDC OFF switch again or restart the
steering input) engine to turn ON the system.
See “Vehicle Dynamic Control (VDC) warning
— oversteer (vehicle tends to spin due to light” (P.2-17) and “Vehicle Dynamic Control
certain road or driving conditions). (VDC) off indicator light” (P.2-19).
The VDC system can help the driver to maintain The computer has a built-in diagnostic feature
control of the vehicle, but it cannot prevent loss that tests the system each time you start the
of vehicle control in all driving situations. engine and move the vehicle forward or in
When the VDC system operates, the VDC reverse at a slow speed. When the self-test
warning light in the instrument panel occurs, you may hear a “clunk” noise and/or
flashes so note the following: feel a pulsation in the brake pedal. This is
normal and is not an indication of a malfunc-
tion.
HILL START ASSIST SYSTEM (if equipped) CRUISE CONTROL (if equipped)
D23A131129-B80DCF91-72A5-4FCF-BD76-0511FBD5355C D23A131129-A6EFB01C-011B-4484-9175-865FCB500F51
. The vehicle is stopped completely on a hill
WARNING: by applying the brake.
. Never rely solely on the hill start assist The maximum holding time is 2 seconds. After
system to prevent the vehicle from mov- 2 seconds the vehicle will begin to roll back and
ing backward on a hill. Always drive the hill start assist system will stop operating
carefully and attentively. Depress the completely.
brake pedal when the vehicle is stopped The hill start assist system will not operate
on a steep hill. Be especially careful when when the transmission is shifted to the “N”
stopped on a hill on frozen or muddy (Neutral) or “P” (Park) position or on a flat and
roads. Failure to prevent the vehicle from level road.
rolling backwards may result in a loss of
When the Vehicle Dynamic Control (VDC) warn-
control of the vehicle and possible ser- JVS0180X
ing light illuminates in the meter, the hill start
ious injury or death.
assist system will not operate. (See “Warning 1. CANCEL switch
. The hill start assist system is not de- lights, indicator lights and audible reminders”
signed to hold the vehicle at a standstill 2. ACCELERATE/RESUME switch
(P.2-13).)
on a hill. Depress the brake pedal when 3. COAST/SET switch
the vehicle is stopped on a steep hill. 4. Cruise control MAIN switch
Failure to do so may cause the vehicle to
roll backwards and may result in a colli- WARNING:
sion or serious personal injury.
. The hill start assist system may not . Always observe the posted speed limits
prevent the vehicle from rolling back- and do not set the speed over them.
wards on a hill under all load or road . Do not use the cruise control when
conditions. Always be prepared to de- driving under the following conditions.
press the brake pedal to prevent the Doing so could cause a loss of vehicle
vehicle from rolling backwards. Failure control and result in an accident.
to do so may result in a collision or — When it is not possible to keep the
serious personal injury. vehicle at a constant speed
The hill start assist system automatically keeps — When driving in heavy traffic
the brakes applied to help prevent the vehicle — When driving in traffic that varies
from rolling backwards in the time it takes the speed
driver to release the brake pedal and apply the
accelerator when the vehicle is stopped on a — When driving in windy areas
hill. — When driving on winding or hilly roads
The hill start assist system will operate auto- — When driving on slippery (rain, snow,
matically under the following conditions: ice, etc.) roads
. The transmission is shifted to a forward or
reverse gear.
SSD0488
Left-Hand Drive (LHD) model
SSD0489
Right-Hand Drive (RHD) model
1. Firmly apply the parking brake. the vehicle forward until the curb side
2. Automatic Transmission (AT) model: Move wheel gently touches the curb. Then apply
the shift lever to the “P” (Park) position. the parking brake.
Manual Transmission (MT) model: Move the HEADED UPHILL WITH CURB
shift lever to the “R” (Reverse) position. Turn the wheels away from the curb and
When parking on an uphill grade, move allow the vehicle to move back until the
the shift lever to the “1” (1st) position. curb side wheel gently touches the curb.
3. To help prevent the vehicle from moving Then apply the parking brake.
into traffic when parked on an incline, it is a HEADED UPHILL OR DOWNHILL, WITHOUT
good practice to turn the wheels as illu- CURB
strated. Turn the wheels toward the side of the
HEADED DOWNHILL WITH CURB road so the vehicle will move away from the
Turn the wheels into the curb and move center of the road if the vehicle moves.
CAUTION:
. Keep the interior of the vehicle as quiet as
possible to hear the tone clearly.
. Keep the sensors (located on the bumper
fascia) free from snow, ice and large
accumulations of dirt. Do not clean the
sensors with sharp objects. If the sensors
are covered, the accuracy of the sensor
function will be diminished.
JVS0532X
The system inform with visual and audible
signal of rear obstacles when the shift lever is
The parking sensor (sonar) system sounds a in the “R” (Reverse) position.
mance or a false activation.
tone to inform the driver of obstacles near the The system is deactivated at speeds above 10
bumper. . This function is designed as an aid to the km/h (6 MPH). It is reactivated at lower speeds.
driver in detecting large stationary ob-
When the “Display” key is ON, the sensor view jects to help avoid damaging the vehicle. The intermittent tone will stop after 3 seconds
will automatically appear in the vehicle infor- The system is not designed to prevent when an obstacle is detected by only the
mation display. contact with small or moving objects. corner sensor and the distance does not
Always move slowly. change. The tone will stop when the obstacle
WARNING: get away from the vehicle.
. The system will not detect small objects
. The parking sensor (sonar) system is a below the bumper, and may not detect
convenience but it is not a substitute for objects close to the bumper or on the
proper parking. The driver is always ground.
responsible for safety during parking . The system may not detect the following
and other manoeuvres. Always look objects.
around and check that it is safe to do so
— Fluffy objects such as snow, cloth,
before parking.
cotton, glass-wool, etc.
. Read and understand the limitations of
— Thin objects such as rope, wire and
the parking sensor (sonar) system as
chain, etc.
contained in this section. The colors of
the corner sensor indicator and the dis- — Wedge-shaped objects
JVS0539X
tance guide lines in the rear view indicate . If your vehicle sustains damage to the
different distances to the object. Incle- bumper fascia, leaving it misaligned or When the corner of the vehicle moves closer to
ment weather or ultrasonic sources such bent, the sensing zone may be altered an object, the corner sensor indicators
as an automatic car wash, a truck’s causing inaccurate measurement of ob- appears.
compressed-air brakes or a pneumatic stacles or false alarms.
drill may affect the function of the sys- When the center of the vehicle moves close to
tem; this may include reduced perfor- an object, the center sensor indicator
appears.
Starting and driving 5-31
Sensor GUID-483AF579-E920-4BE2-BD41-DC59FAA8379C
Activate or deactivate the use of sensor.
ON (default) - OFF
JVS0534X
Volume GUID-5D011009-113A-41BD-AA19-19E90799F683
The parking sensor (sonar) system OFF switch Adjust the volume of the tone.
on the instrument panel allows the driver to High - Med. (default) - Low
turn the parking sensor (sonar) system on and
off. To turn the parking sensor (sonar) system Range GUID-D8DD3225-FFD0-4D61-B68A-CD7779A81841
on and off, the ignition switch must be in the Adjust the detection range of the sensor.
“ON” position.
Far - Mid. (default) - Near
The indicator light on the switch will
illuminate when the system is turned on.
If the indicator light flashes when the parking
sensor (sonar) system is not turned off, it may
indicate a malfunction in the parking sensor
(sonar) system.
The parking sensor (sonar) system will be
turned on automatically under the following
conditions:
POWER STEERING
D23A131129-87C8421D-559D-43F2-B29C-3246CB23890A
Maximum rear gross axle weight SAFETY CHAINS
GUID-480CDF74-7704-4521-90B5-6F5071EA15F9 GUID-85C2A662-2BA3-4AB1-B59A-032DAF764C45 WARNING:
Always use a suitable chain between the
vehicle and trailer. The chain should be crossed If the engine is not running or is turned off
and should be attached to the hitch, not to the while driving, the power assist for the steer-
vehicle bumper or axle. Be sure to leave enough ing will not work. The steering will be much
slack in the chain to permit turning corners. harder to operate.
TRAILER D23A131129-69ACDC13-5C3E-4015-8572-6585B65A098C
BRAKES The power assisted steering is designed to use
a hydraulic pump driven by the engine, to assist
Ensure that trailer brakes are installed as
steering.
required by local regulations. Also check that
all other trailer equipment conforms to local If the engine stops or the drive belt breaks, you
regulations. will still have control of the vehicle. However,
CA0050 greater steering effort is needed, especially in
Always block the wheels on both the vehicle
sharp turns and at low speeds.
The rear gross axle weight must not exceed the and trailer when parking. Apply the hand brake
Gross Axle Weight Rating (GAWR). on the trailer if equipped. Parking on a steep
GAWR: slope is not recommended.
Rear If parking on a steep slope is unavoidable, place
YS23DDT/DDTT engine with 195R15C the shift lever in the “P” (Park) position (Auto-
and 255/60R18 tire equipped models matic transmission model), or in an appropriate
1,700 kg (3,749 lb) position (Manual transmission model), and turn
Except for YS23DDT/DDTT engine with the front wheels towards the curb.
195R15C and 255/60R18 tire equipped
models TRAILER D23A131129-14BC0770-373C-4B96-B07B-7EC869ED2A85
DETECTION (if equipped)
1,750 kg (3,859 lb) When towing a trailer with a genuine NISSAN
tow bar electrical kit and the turn signal switch
The trailer must be loaded so that heavy goods is used, the electrical system of the vehicle will
are placed over the axle. detect the additional electrical load of the
trailer lighting. As a result, the direction indi-
TIRE PRESSURE
GUID-1EC22036-023B-4940-83A4-7F672CD3342F cator tone will be different.
When towing a trailer, inflate the vehicle tires to
the maximum recommended COLD tire pres-
sure (for full loading) indicated on the tire
placard.
Do not tow a trailer when the vehicle is installed
with a temporary spare tire or a compact spare
tire.
BRAKE SYSTEM
D23A131129-943CB8CC-7A93-4635-838C-02D7D2292797
The brake system has two separate hydraulic Wet brakes ANTI-LOCK BRAKING SYSTEM (ABS) (if
circuits. If one circuit malfunctions, you will still D23A131129-47B5DF9F-42DB-4939-8B98-06F9D4E0CB02
have braking ability at two wheels. When the vehicle is washed or driven through equipped)
D23A131129-9869AB77-87E9-4609-A21B-1BD9B918266C
water, the brakes may get wet. As a result, your
BRAKE PRECAUTIONS braking distance will be longer and the vehicle WARNING:
D23A131129-B0E4998A-846B-4FEB-BFD6-689E6A742199
may pull to one side during braking.
Vacuum assisted brakes The Anti-lock Braking System (ABS) is a
D23A131129-B79B7AF5-3AF9-49F1-973E-41C0E1227FF7 To dry the brakes, drive the vehicle at a safe sophisticated device, but it cannot prevent
The brake booster aids braking by using engine speed while lightly depressing the foot brake accidents resulting from careless or danger-
vacuum. If the engine stops, you can stop the pedal to heat up the brakes. Do this until the ous driving techniques. It can help maintain
vehicle by depressing the foot brake pedal. brakes return to normal. Avoid driving the vehicle control during braking on slippery
However, greater foot pressure on the foot vehicle at high speeds until the brakes function surfaces. Remember that stopping distances
brake pedal will be required to stop the vehicle. correctly. on slippery surfaces will be longer than on
The stopping distance will be longer. normal surfaces even with ABS. Stopping
If the engine is not running or is turned off
Parking brake break-in
D23A131129-978FD217-606F-4D72-B7E4-297404318734 distances may also be longer on rough,
while driving, the power assisted brakes will not Break in the parking brake shoes whenever the gravel or snow covered roads, or if you are
function. Braking will be harder. stopping effect of the parking brake is wea- using tire chains. Always maintain a safe
kened or whenever the parking brake shoes distance from the vehicle in front of you.
WARNING: and/or drums/rotors are replaced, in order to Ultimately, the driver is responsible for
assure the best braking performance. safety.
Do not coast with the engine stopped. This procedure is described in the vehicle
service manual and can be performed by a Tire type and condition may also affect
Using brakes NISSAN dealer. braking effectiveness.
D23A131129-87D8A2FA-59DD-4B7D-A620-25C82316B771
Avoid resting your foot on the foot brake pedal . When replacing tires, install the specified
while driving. This will overheat the brakes, BRAKE ASSIST (if equipped)
GUID-B1831EA3-8A07-48FC-ADA0-90BAD6A0FA0F size of tires on all four wheels.
wear out the brake linings/pads faster, and When the force applied to the brake pedal . When installing a spare tire, make sure
increase fuel consumption. exceeds a certain level, the Brake Assist is that it is the proper size and type as
activated generating greater braking force specified on the tire placard. (See “Tire
To help reduce brake wear and to prevent the
than a conventional brake booster even with placard” (P.9-15).)
brakes from overheating, reduce speed and
light pedal force. . For detailed information, see “Tires and
downshift to a lower gear before going down a
slope or long grade. Overheated brakes may wheels” (P.8-32).
reduce braking performance and could result WARNING: The Anti-lock Braking System (ABS) controls
in loss of vehicle control. the brakes so the wheels do not lock during
The Brake Assist is only an aid to assist
hard braking or when braking on slippery
While driving on a slippery surface, be careful braking operation and is not a collision
surfaces. The system detects the rotation
when braking, accelerating or downshifting. warning or avoidance device. It is the driver’s
speed at each wheel and varies the brake fluid
Abrupt braking or acceleration could cause responsibility to stay alert, drive safely and
pressure to prevent each wheel from locking
the wheels to skid and result in an accident. be in control of the vehicle at all times.
and sliding. By preventing each wheel from
locking, the system helps the driver maintain
steering control and helps to minimize swer-
ving and spinning on slippery surfaces.
VEHICLE SECURITY
D23A131129-3379387A-C03F-4BBD-9228-95DD384B5AEF
Using system feel a vibration from the actuator when it is When leaving your vehicle unoccupied:
D23A131129-468B0649-A666-40E4-A4BE-4A9D909844D6
operating. This is normal and indicates that the . Always take the key with you - even when
Depress the brake pedal and hold it down.
ABS is operating properly. However, the pulsa- leaving the vehicle in your own garage.
Depress the brake pedal with firm steady
tion may indicate that road conditions are . Close all windows completely and lock all
pressure, but do not pump the brakes. The
hazardous and extra care is required while doors.
ABS will operate to prevent the wheels from
driving.
locking up. Steer the vehicle to avoid obstacles. . Always park your vehicle where it can be
When the differential lock (if equipped) is seen. Park in a well lit area during the night.
WARNING: engaged, the ABS warning light illuminates. . If the security system is equipped, use it -
This indicates that the anti-lock function is not even for a short period.
Do not pump the brake pedal. Doing so may fully operating. (See “Rear differential locking
result in increased stopping distances. system” (P.5-23) for the rear differential lock . Never leave children or pets in the vehicle
function.) unattended.
. Never leave valuables inside the vehicle.
Self-test D23A131129-AA5A2FB9-74FD-480F-8A75-EE2F2D342E6B
feature Always take valuables with you.
The ABS includes electronic sensors, electric . Never leave the vehicle documents in the
pumps, hydraulic solenoids and a computer. vehicle.
The computer has a built-in diagnostic feature
. Never leave articles on a roof rack. Remove
that tests the system each time you start the
them from the rack and keep and lock
engine and move the vehicle at a low speed in
them inside the vehicle.
forward or reverse. When the self-test occurs,
you may hear a “clunk” noise and/or feel a . Never leave the spare key in the vehicle.
pulsation in the brake pedal. This is normal and
does not indicate a malfunction. If the compu-
ter senses a malfunction, it switches the ABS
off and illuminates the ABS warning light on the
instrument panel. The brake system then
operates normally, but without anti-lock assis-
tance. If the ABS warning light illuminates
during the self-test or while driving, have the
vehicle checked by a NISSAN dealer.
Normal D23A131129-6AE7A07C-6596-439E-A05B-643D6BD02DAA
operation
The ABS operates at speeds above 5 to 10
km/h (3 to 6 MPH). The speed varies according
to road conditions.
When the ABS senses that one or more wheels
are close to locking up, the actuator rapidly
applies and releases hydraulic pressure. This
action is similar to pumping the brakes very
quickly. You may feel a pulsation in the brake
pedal and hear a noise from under the hood or
CORROSION PROTECTION
D23A131129-D5D7F310-073E-4924-913D-1CBFB66C7D76
Chemicals used for road surface deicing are
extremely corrosive and will accelerate corro-
sion and the deterioration of underbody com-
ponents such as the exhaust system, fuel and
brake lines, brake cables, floor pan and fenders.
In the winter, the underbody must be cleaned
periodically. For additional information, see
“Corrosion protection” (P.7-5) of this manual.
For additional protection against rust and
corrosion, which may be required in some
areas, consult a NISSAN dealer.
6 In case of emergency
The jack and tools are stored under the jump For Single Cab model REMOVING THE SPARE TIRE
GUID-C731C0AE-0AAD-4548-AFD2-4228FD45D752 GUID-40F76BEC-AF3F-4F5D-8B66-A0E091B1DB98
seat.
JVR0417X
JVE0202X
SCE0514
through the opening and direct it towards the When storing the wheel, be sure to mount the WARNING:
spare tire winch, located directly above the wheel horizontally. Securing a wheel that is
spare tire. in a tilted position as illustrated may cause . Be sure to read and follow the instruc-
Seat the T-shaped end of the jack rod into the looseness and dropping of the wheel while tions in this section.
T-shaped opening of the spare tire winch, and driving. Lower the wheel on the ground . DO NOT GET UNDER A VEHICLE THAT IS
turn the jack rod counterclockwise to lower again, and make sure that the hanging plate SUPPORTED BY A JACK.
the spare tire. is properly set. Hang the wheel again and . Never use a jack which was not provided
make sure that the wheel is held horizontally,
Once the spare tire is completely lowered , with your vehicle.
then store the wheel.
reach under the vehicle, remove the retainer . The jack, which is provided with your
chain, and carefully slide the tire from under vehicle, is designed only to lift your
the rear of the vehicle. BLOCKING WHEELS
D23A131129-8395098A-ABB8-49F8-B42E-63A3D5E2646F vehicle during a tire change.
. Never jack up the vehicle at a location
other than the jack-up point that is
specified.
. Never lift the vehicle more than neces-
sary.
. Never use blocks on or under the jack.
. Never start or run the engine while the
vehicle is on the jack. The vehicle may
move suddenly, and this may cause an
accident.
MCE0001D
. Never allow passengers to remain in the
vehicle while the tire is off the ground.
WARNING: . Be sure to read the caution label attached
Be sure to block the appropriate wheel to to the jack body before using.
prevent the vehicle from moving, which may
cause personal injury.
Place suitable blocks at both the front and
back of the wheel diagonally opposite the flat
tire to prevent the vehicle from moving when
it is jacked up.
SCE0982
SCE0139H
JVE0212X
For leaf suspension models
Removing tire
D23A131129-066AD6B2-BA09-42A4-85B3-B5EF13C4DC91
1. Remove the wheel nuts.
2. Remove the damaged tire.
CAUTION:
The tire is heavy. Be sure that your feet are
clear from the tire and use gloves as neces-
sary to avoid injury.
JVE0231X
For coil suspension models
For front wheel
For rear wheel
1. Place the jack directly under the jack-up
points or as illustrated.
The jack should be placed on firm level
ground.
JVE0208X
2. Loosen each wheel nut, counterclockwise,
one or two turns with the wheel nut
wrench. WARNING:
Do not remove the wheel nuts until the . Never use wheel nuts which are not
NCE130
tire is off the ground. provided with your vehicle. Incorrect
3. Install the assembled jack rod into the jack wheel nuts or improperly tightened
as shown. wheel nuts may cause the wheel to
4. Carefully raise the vehicle until the clear- become loose or come off. This could
ance between the tire and ground is cause an accident.
achieved. . Never use oil or grease on the wheel
studs or nuts. This may cause the wheel
nuts to become loose.
JUMP STARTING
D23A131129-EE3D792C-AD0C-46DF-9465-D06434453F20
. The temporary-use spare tire (if STOWING DAMAGED TIRE AND TOOLS
equipped) is designed for emergency D23A131129-ADE46C5C-5C07-4076-AF08-8049224EE449 WARNING:
use only. WARNING: . Incorrect jump starting can lead to a
1. Clean any mud or dirt from the surface battery explosion. The battery explosion
. Be sure that the tire, jack and tools are may result in severe injury or death. It
between the wheel and hub. properly stored after use. Such items can may also result in damage to the vehicle.
2. Carefully put the spare tire on and tighten become dangerous projectiles in an acci- Be sure to follow the instructions in this
the wheel nuts with your fingers. Check dent or sudden stop. section.
that all the wheel nuts contact the wheel . The temporary-use spare tire (if
surface horizontally. . Explosive hydrogen gas is always present
equipped) is designed for emergency in the vicinity of the battery. Keep all
3. Tighten the wheel nuts alternately and use only. sparks and flames away from the battery.
evenly in the sequence illustrated ( - ),
more than 2 times with the wheel nut Securely store the damaged tire, jack and tools . Always wear suitable eye protection and
wrench, until they are tight. in the storage area in the reverse order of remove rings, bracelets, and any other
removal. (See “Preparing tools” (P.6-2) and jewelry whenever working on or near a
4. Lower the vehicle slowly until the tire “Removing the spare tire” (P.6-3).) battery.
touches the ground.
. Never lean over the battery while jump
5. Tighten the wheel nuts securely, with the starting.
wheel nut wrench, in the sequence illu-
strated. . Never allow battery fluid to come into
contact with eyes, skin, clothes or the
6. Lower the vehicle completely. vehicle’s painted surfaces. Battery fluid is
Tighten the wheel nuts to the specified a corrosive sulfuric acid which can cause
torque with a torque wrench as soon as severe burns. If the fluid comes into
possible. contact with anything, immediately flush
Wheel nut tightening torque: the contacted area with plenty of water.
133 N·m (13.6 kg-m, 98 ft-lb) . Keep the battery out of the reach of
children.
The wheel nuts must be kept tightened to
specification at all times. It is recommended . The booster battery must be rated at 12
that the wheel nuts be tightened to specifi- volts. Use of an incorrectly rated battery
cation at each lubrication interval. will damage your vehicle.
. Never attempt to jump start a frozen
WARNING: battery. It could explode and cause ser-
ious injury.
Retighten the wheel nuts when the vehicle
has been driven for 1,000 km (600 miles)
(also in case of a flat tire, etc.).
JVE0232X
QR25DE engine models
JVE0235X
YD25DDTi engine models
CAUTION:
. Always connect positive + to positive +
and negative 7 to body ground, NOT to
the battery’s negative 7.
. Be sure that the jumper cables do not
touch moving parts in the engine com-
partment.
. Be sure that the jumper cable’s clamps do
JVE0233X not contact any other metal.
YS23DDT/DDTT engine models 9. Start the engine of the booster vehicle
1. If the booster battery is in another vehicle “OFF” position. Supply power using jum- and let it run for a few minutes.
, position the two vehicles and to per cables before pushing the ignition
bring the batteries into close proximity to 10. Depress the accelerator pedal of the boos-
switch to any position other than the ter vehicle at about 2,000 rpm.
each other. “OFF” position and disengaging the steer-
ing lock. 11. Start the engine of the jumped vehicle in
CAUTION: the normal manner.
2. Apply the parking brake.
. Do not allow the two vehicles to touch. CAUTION:
3. Automatic transmission (AT) model:
. If the battery of vehicle equipped with
the Intelligent Key system is discharged, Move the shift lever to the “P” (Park) Never keep the starter motor engaged for
the steering wheel will lock and cannot position. more than 10 seconds. If the engine does not
be turned with the ignition switch in the Manual transmission (MT) model: start right away, place the ignition switch in
the “LOCK” position and wait at least 10
JVE0204X
Right-Hand Drive model
The layout illustrated is for the Right-Hand
Drive (RHD) model. On the Left-Hand Drive (LHD)
model, the towing hook is located on the
opposite side.
WARNING:
. Never allow anyone to stand near the
towing line during the pulling operation.
. Never spin the tires at high speed. This
could cause them to explode and result in
JVE0209X
serious injury. Parts of the vehicle could
ACE0705 NISSAN recommends that your vehicle be also overheat and be damaged.
towed with all wheels off the ground as In the event that your vehicle’s tires become
illustrated or place the vehicle on a flatbed trapped in sand, snow, or mud, and the vehicle
truck. is unable to free itself without being pulled, use
the towing hook.
CAUTION: . Use the towing hook only. Do not attach
Never tow 4WD models with any of the the pulling device to any other part of the
wheels on the ground. Doing so will cause vehicle body. Otherwise, the vehicle body
serious and expensive damage to the drive- may be damaged.
train. . Use the towing hook to free a vehicle only.
Never tow a vehicle using only the towing
hook.
CAUTION:
In order to not break the towing line, tension
it slowly.
MEMO
CLEANING EXTERIOR
D23A131129-2C1475A6-F2C1-42EF-BC13-19870821EE84
In order to maintain the appearance of your . Do not wash the vehicle in direct sunlight . Spray water to the underbody and in the
vehicle, it is important to take proper care of it. or while the vehicle body is hot, as the wheel wells to loosen the dirt and/or wash
paint surface may become water- away road salt.
Whenever possible, park your vehicle inside a spotted.
garage or in a covered area to minimize the REMOVING SPOTS
. Avoid using tight-napped or rough cloths, D23A131129-6D039294-F855-4C03-8E99-80C6C84682C7
chances of damaging the paint surface of your
vehicle. such as washing mitts. Care must be Remove tar and oil spots, industrial dust,
taken when removing caked-on dirt or insects, and tree sap as quickly as possible
When it is necessary to park outside, park in a from the paint surface to avoid lasting damage
shady area or protect the vehicle with a body other foreign substances so the paint
surface is not scratched or damaged. or staining. Special cleaning products are
cover. Be careful not to scratch the paint available at a NISSAN dealer or any automotive
surface when putting on or removing the . Lock all doors before going through accessory store.
body cover. automatic car wash. Locking doors helps
prevent fuel-filler lid from opening and WAXING D23A131129-24E6F882-0573-4260-86FB-6F3FA0A23C19
WASHING
D23A131129-52CA2A90-9B93-4E97-985F-079D905A0AAE becoming damaged. Regular waxing protects the paint surface and
In the following instances, wash your vehicle as helps maintain a new vehicle appearance.
. For models with decorative sticker, ob-
soon as possible to protect the paint surface:
serve the following: After waxing, polishing is recommended to
. After a rainfall, which may cause the paint remove built-up residue and to avoid a weath-
surface damage from acid rain. — Wash dirt off the vehicle with a wet
sponge and plenty of water. Then ered appearance.
. After driving on coastal roads, which may wipe the vehicle gently using a soft A NISSAN dealer can assist you in choosing the
cause rusting from the sea breeze. cloth. appropriate waxing products.
. When contaminants such as soot, bird
droppings, tree sap, metal particles or bugs — Do not apply direct water pressure,
such as high-pressure sprayer, on the CAUTION:
get on the paint surface.
. When dust or mud builds up on the paint vehicle body around the sticker. This . Wash your vehicle thoroughly and com-
surface. may cause the sticker edges to peel pletely before applying wax to the paint
away or come off from the vehicle. surface.
1. Wash the vehicle surface with a wet sponge
and plenty of water. 3. Rinse the vehicle thoroughly with plenty of . Always follow the manufacturer’s instruc-
2. Clean the vehicle surface gently and thor- clean water. tions supplied with the wax.
oughly using a mild soap, a special vehicle 4. Use a dampened chamois to dry the paint . Do not use a wax containing any abra-
soap or a general purpose dishwashing surface and avoid leaving water spots. sives, cutting compounds or cleaners
liquid mixed with clean, lukewarm (never that may damage the vehicle finish.
hot) water. When washing the vehicle, take care of the
following: Machine compounding or aggressive polishing
. Inside flanges, joints and folds on the doors, on a base coat/clear coat paint finish may dull
CAUTION: the finish or leave swirl marks.
hatches and hood are particularly vulner-
. Do not wash the vehicle with strong able to the effects of road salt. Therefore,
household soap, strong chemical deter- these areas must be cleaned regularly.
gents, gasoline or solvents. . Be sure that the drain holes in the lower
edge of the doors are not clogged.
GLASS D23A131129-5F272933-652F-4477-9808-C6F712A65783
ALUMINUM ALLOY WHEELS
D23A131129-9208A50C-BAB6-40FD-9E69-1ACA9E664A64
CHROMED23A131129-A45ADD0A-D2C3-4DE6-9BA8-E87AAE41F658
PARTS
Use glass cleaner to remove smoke and dust Wash the wheels regularly with a sponge Clean all chrome parts regularly with a non-
film from the glass surfaces. It is normal for dampened in a mild soap solution, especially abrasive chrome polish to maintain the finish.
glass to become coated with a film after the during winter in areas where road salt is used.
vehicle is parked in the hot sun. Glass cleaner The salt residue from road salt could discolor
and a soft cloth will easily remove this film. the wheels if it is not washed off regularly.
UNDERBODY
D23A131129-E8FB3E0B-FA23-415E-AF19-FFD0C0F73D65 CAUTION:
In areas where road salt is used in the winter, it
is necessary to clean the vehicle’s underbody Follow the directions below to avoid staining
regularly in order to prevent dirt and salt from or discoloring the wheels:
building up and causing the acceleration of . Do not use a cleaner that uses strong acid
corrosion on the underbody and suspension. or alkali contents to clean the wheels.
Before the winter and again in the spring, the . Do not apply wheel cleaners to the
underseal must be checked and, if necessary, wheels when they are hot. The wheel
re-treated. temperature should be the same as
ambient temperature.
WHEELS D23A131129-F3433C47-E23B-43DD-9EA7-BC455ABB3E7B
. Rinse the wheel to completely remove
. Wash the wheels when washing the vehicle the cleaner within 15 minutes after the
to maintain their appearance. cleaner is applied.
. Clean the inner side of the wheels when the
wheel is changed or the underside of the SIDE STEP BOARDS (if equipped)
vehicle is washed. GUID-2C643168-A941-49DD-A295-F7D1588D2EC7
CLEANING INTERIOR
D23A131129-2EB96DB0-EC26-4717-8559-EF1F5A9D89C1
Occasionally remove loose dust from the inter- AIR FRESHENERS Floor mat positioning aid
ior trim, plastic parts and seats using a vacuum D23A131129-FA2A8AC5-49FC-4603-BBED-21B6BEFFA035 D23A131129-22B0FB6B-8E5A-4F97-A6CA-B63DA7A84991
cleaner or soft bristled brush. Wipe the vinyl Most air fresheners use a solvent that could
and leather surfaces with a clean, soft cloth affect the vehicle interior. If you use an air
dampened in mild soap solution, then wipe freshener, take the following precautions:
clean with a dry, soft cloth. . Hanging-type air fresheners can cause
Regular care and cleaning is required in order permanent discoloration when they con-
to maintain the appearance of the leather. tact vehicle interior surfaces. Place the air
freshener in a location that allows it to
Before using any fabric protector, read the hang free and not contact an interior
manufacturer’s recommendations. Some fabric surface.
protectors contain chemicals that may stain or . Liquid-type air fresheners typically clip on
bleach the seat material. the vents. These products can cause im-
Use a soft cloth dampened only with water to mediate damage and discoloration when JVA0022X
clean the meter and gauge lens covers. spilled on interior surfaces. Example
Carefully read and follow the manufacturer’s This vehicle includes floor mat brackets to act
CAUTION: instructions before using air fresheners. as a floor mat positioning aid. NISSAN floor
mats have been specially designed for your
. Never use benzine, thinner or any similar FLOOR MATS vehicle model.
D23A131129-1B314048-1190-4006-BB9A-CBB1718218B2
material.
The use of genuine NISSAN floor mats (if Position the mat by placing the floor mat
. Small dirt particles can be abrasive and equipped) can extend the life of your vehicle bracket hook through the floor mat grommet
damaging to leather surfaces and should carpet and make it easier to clean the interior. hole while centering the mat in the foot area.
be removed promptly. Do not use saddle Regardless of what mats are used, be sure they
soap, car waxes, polishes, oils, cleaning Periodically check that the mats are properly
are fitted for your vehicle and are properly positioned.
fluids, solvents, detergents or ammonia- positioned in the foot well to prevent inter-
based cleaners as they damage the ference with pedal operation. Mats should be
leather natural finish.
GLASS D23A131129-9761A1A8-C4ED-46D9-9C09-F4950BF5F3CC
maintained with regular cleaning and replaced
if they become excessively worn. Use glass cleaner to remove smoke and dust
. Never use fabric protectors unless re-
film from the glass surfaces. It is normal for
commended by the manufacturer.
glass to become coated with a film after the
. Do not use glass or plastic cleaner on vehicle is parked in the hot sun. Glass cleaner
meter or gauge lens covers. It may and a soft cloth will easily remove this film.
damage the lens covers.
CAUTION:
When cleaning the inside of the windows, do
not use sharp-edged tools, abrasive cleaners
or chlorine-based disinfectant cleaners. They
could damage the electrical conductors, such
as radio antenna elements or rear window
defogger elements.
CORROSION PROTECTION
D23A131129-88A6F4F0-C55B-4C54-9334-304853510A3E
SEAT BELTS
D23A131129-FE5CC456-C87A-4BAB-BC26-0344E0699D4D MOST COMMON FACTORS CONTRI- TO PROTECT YOUR VEHICLE FROM
BUTING TO VEHICLE CORROSION CORROSION
D23A131129-3347F399-5EAD-40C8-8FE4-20C72DDAD308
D23A131129-68180AEC-B281-4CBA-8800-5C71C7841E52
WARNING: . Wash and wax your vehicle often to keep
. The accumulation of moisture-retaining
. Do not allow wet seat belts to roll up in dirt and debris in body panel sections, the vehicle clean.
the retractor. cavities, and other areas. . Always check for minor damage to the
. Damage to the paint surface and other paint surface and if any exists, repair it as
. Never use bleach, dye or chemical sol-
protective coatings caused by gravel and soon as possible.
vents to clean the seat belts, since these
materials may severely weaken the seat stone chips or minor traffic accidents. . Keep the drain holes in the lower edge of
belt webbing. the doors open to avoid water accumula-
ENVIRONMENTAL FACTORS INFLUENCE tion.
The seat belts can be cleaned by wiping them THE RATED23A131129-9F4F2623-2EB3-4361-BD51-00CB2422B44F
OF CORROSION . Check the vehicle underbody for accumu-
with a sponge dampened in a mild soap lation of sand, dirt or salt. If present, wash
solution. MoistureD23A131129-4650C177-5FD9-4D3D-B04A-9C7C7BD90460 with water as soon as possible.
Allow the belts to dry completely in the shade The accumulation of sand, dirt and water on
before using them. (See “Seat belts” (P.1-8).) the inside floor of the vehicle can accelerate CAUTION:
corrosion. Wet floor carpet/floor mats will not
dry completely inside the vehicle. They should . Never remove dirt, sand or other debris
be removed and completely dried to avoid floor from the passenger compartment by
panel corrosion. washing it out with a hose. Remove dirt
with a vacuum cleaner.
Relative humidity
D23A131129-4183169E-6E23-4B79-9D33-52C71E1DE663 . Never allow water or other liquids to
Corrosion will be accelerated in areas of high come in contact with electronic compo-
relative humidity. nents inside the vehicle as this may
damage them.
Temperature
D23A131129-E477FDFB-4836-4774-8832-6318E7E4B86B
Chemicals used for road surface deicing are
High temperatures accelerate the rate of
extremely corrosive. They accelerate corrosion
corrosion to those parts which are not well
and deterioration of underbody components
ventilated.
such as the exhaust system, fuel and brake
Corrosion will also be accelerated in areas lines, brake cables, floor pan and fenders.
where the temperatures stay above freezing.
In the winter, the underbody must be cleaned
Air pollution periodically.
D23A131129-05B60743-6EE4-46A4-BAF5-B6871C45413F
Industrial pollution, the presence of salt in the For additional protection against rust and
air in coastal areas, or heavy road salt use corrosion, which may be required in some
accelerates the corrosion process. Road salt areas, consult a NISSAN dealer.
also accelerates the disintegration of paint
surfaces.
MEMO
Tires*: D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
Wheel alignment and balance:
D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
Parking brake*:
D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
Check the pressure with a gauge often and If the vehicle should pull to either side while Check the parking brake operation regularly.
always prior to long distance trips. Adjust the driving on a straight and level road, or if you Check that the lever (if so equipped) or the
pressure in all tires, including the spare, to the detect uneven or abnormal tire wear, there pedal (if so equipped) has the proper travel.
pressure specified. Check carefully for damage, may be a need for wheel alignment. If the Also make sure that the vehicle is held securely
cuts or excessive wear. steering wheel or seat vibrates at normal on a fairly steep hill when only the parking
highway speeds, wheel balancing may be brake is applied.
Tire rotation*:
D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8 needed.
In the case that Two-Wheel Drive (2WD) and Seat belts: D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
front and rear tires are same size; tires should Windshield:D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8 Check that all parts of the seat belt system (for
be rotated every 10,000 km (6,000 miles). Tires Clean the windshield on a regular basis. Check example, buckles, anchors, adjusters and re-
marked with directional indicators can only be the windshield at least every six months for tractors) operate properly and smoothly, and
rotated between front and rear. Make sure that cracks or other damage. Repair as necessary. are installed securely. Check the belt webbing
the directional indicators point in the direction for cuts, fraying, wear or damage.
of wheel rotation after the tire rotation is Wiper blades*:
D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
completed. Check for cracks or wear if not functioning Steering wheel:
D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
correctly. Replace as necessary. Check for changes in the steering condition,
In the case that Four-Wheel Drive and All Wheel
such as excessive play, hard steering or strange
Drive (4WD/AWD) and front and rear tires are Inside vehicle noises.
same size; tires should be rotated every 5,000 D23A131129-C30F89A2-BD24-450C-BE29-CACC3954D796
km (3,000 miles). Tires marked with directional The maintenance items listed here should be Warning lights and chimes:
indicators can only be rotated between front checked on a regular basis, such as when D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
performing periodic maintenance, cleaning Make sure that all warning lights and chimes
and rear. Make sure that the directional in- are operating properly.
dicators point in the direction of wheel rotation the vehicle, etc.
after the tire rotation is completed. AcceleratorD23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
pedal: Windshield D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
defogger:
In the case that front tires are different size Check the pedal for smooth operation and Check that the air comes out of the defogger
from rear tires; tires cannot be rotated. make sure that the pedal does not catch or outlets properly and in good quantity when
The timing for tire rotation may vary according require uneven effort. Keep the floor mats away operating the heater or air conditioner.
to your driving habits and the road surface from the pedal. Windshield D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
wiper and washer*:
conditions. Brake pedal*: Check that the wipers and washer operate
D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Check the pedal for smooth operation and properly and that the wipers do not streak.
transmitterD23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
components (if so equipped): make sure that it is the proper distance from
the floor mat when depressed fully. Check the Under hood and vehicle
D23A131129-292CAE27-FEEB-4E90-AF7A-3CF671B66363
Replace the TPMS transmitter grommet seal,
valve core and cap when the tires are replaced brake booster function. Be sure to keep the The maintenance items listed here should be
due to wear or age. floor mats away from the pedal. checked periodically (for example, each time
you check the engine oil or refuel).
Battery (except for maintenance free bat- Power steering fluid level and lines*: . If you must run the engine in an enclosed
D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
teries)*: Check the level when the fluid is cold with the space such as a garage, be sure there is
D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
engine off. Check the lines for proper attach- proper ventilation for exhaust gases to
Check the fluid level in each cell. It should be
ment, leaks, cracks, etc. escape.
between the UPPER and LOWER lines. Vehicles
operated in high temperatures or under severe . Never get under the vehicle while it is
Windshield D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
washer fluid*: supported by a jack.
conditions require frequent checks of the
battery fluid level. Check that there is adequate fluid in the . Keep smoking materials, flame and
reservoir. sparks away from fuel and the battery.
Brake (and D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
clutch) fluid level(s)*:
For Manual Transmission (MT) model; make MAINTENANCE PRECAUTIONS
D23A131129-043D059F-5005-4A6E-BCBD-FE125C83927C
. Never connect or disconnect either the
sure that the brake and clutch fluid levels are When performing any inspection or mainte- battery or any transistorized component
between the MAX and MIN lines on the reser- nance work on your vehicle, always take care to connector while the ignition switch is in
voirs. prevent serious accidental injury to yourself or the “ON” position.
Except for Manual Transmission (MT) model; damage to the vehicle. The following are . On gasoline engine models with the
make sure that the brake fluid level is between general precautions which should be closely Multiport Fuel Injection (MFI) system, the
the MAX and MIN lines on the reservoir. observed. fuel filter and fuel lines should be ser-
viced by a NISSAN dealer because the fuel
Engine coolant level*:
D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8 WARNING: lines are under high pressure even when
Check the coolant level when the engine is the engine is turned off.
cold. Make sure that the coolant level is . Park the vehicle on a level surface, apply
. Your vehicle is equipped with an auto-
between the MAX and MIN lines on the reser- the parking brake securely and block the
matic engine cooling fan. It may come on
voir. wheels to prevent the vehicle from mov-
at any time without warning, even if the
ing. Move the shift lever to the “P” (Park)
Engine drive belt(s)*: ignition switch is in the “OFF” position
position (AT model) or the shift lever to
D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8 and the engine is not running. To avoid
Make sure that drive belt(s) is not frayed, worn, the “N” (Neutral) position (MT model).
injury, always disconnect the negative
cracked or oily. . Be sure the ignition switch is in the battery cable before working near the
Engine oil level*: “LOCK” position when performing any fan.
D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8 parts replacement or repairs.
Check the level after parking the vehicle (on a . Always wear eye protection whenever
level ground) and turning off the engine. . Do not work under the hood while the you work on your vehicle.
engine is hot. Always turn off the engine
. Never leave the engine or the transmis-
Fluid leaks:D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8 and wait until it cools down.
sion related component harness connec-
Check under the vehicle for fuel, oil, water or . If you must work with the engine running, tor disconnected while the ignition
other fluid leaks after the vehicle has been keep your hands, clothing, hair and tools switch is in the “ON” position.
parked for a while. Water dripping from the air away from moving fans, belts and any
conditioner after use is normal. If you should . Avoid direct contact with used engine oil
other moving parts.
notice any leaks or if fuel fumes are evident, and coolant. Improperly disposed engine
. It is advisable to secure or remove any oil, engine coolant, and/or other vehicle
check for cause and have it corrected immedi- loose clothing and any jewelry, such as
ately. fluids can hurt the environment. Always
rings, watches, etc. before working on conform to local regulations for disposal
your vehicle. of vehicle fluids.
This “8. Maintenance and do-it-yourself” section
8-4 Maintenance and do-it-yourself
JVC0772X
YD25DDTi ENGINE
D23A131129-FE34AD79-9FED-4C44-B5AF-8F46493E8FB6
JVC0665X
CAUTION:
. Never use any cooling system additives
such as radiator sealer. Additives may
clog the cooling system and cause da-
mage to the engine, transmission and/or
cooling system.
. When adding or replacing coolant, be
sure to use only Genuine NISSAN Engine
JVC0773X Coolant or equivalent in its quality with
the proper mixture ratio. Examples of the
1. Window washer fluid reservoir 9. Engine drive belt location mixture ratio of coolant and water are
2. Brake and clutch* fluid reservoir 10. Radiator filler cap shown in the following table:
3. Engine oil dipstick 11. Power steering fluid reservoir
4. Engine oil filler cap *: For Manual Transmission (MT) model
5. Fuse/fusible link holder
6. Battery
7. Air cleaner
8. Engine coolant reservoir
ENGINE OIL
D23A131129-10680CA8-8B78-40B1-A83A-227B79D2E364
CAUTION:
. The oil level should be checked regularly.
Operating your vehicle with an insuffi-
cient amount of oil can damage the
engine, and such damage is not covered Engine oil and filter
D23A131129-3C60555F-9670-4DBC-90EA-5462503BFEF4
by the warranty.
For QR25DED23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
and YD25DDTi engine model:
. It is normal to add some oil between oil
maintenance intervals or during the
break-in period, depending on the sever-
ity of operating conditions.
WARNING:
. Used oil must be disposed of properly.
Never pour or dump oil into the ground,
canals, rivers, etc. It should be disposed
of at proper waste facilities. NISSAN
recommends having your oil changed by
a NISSAN dealer.
. Be careful not to burn yourself, as the
engine oil may be hot.
. Prolonged and repeated contact with
used engine oil may cause skin cancer.
. Avoid direct skin contact with used oil. If
contacted, wash thoroughly with soap or
hand cleaner and plenty of water as soon
as possible.
JVM0542X
. Store used engine oil in marked contain-
QR25DE engine (for 2WD with Manual Transmission
ers out of the reach of children. for Australia and New Zealand)
JVM0531X
Vehicle set-up
D23A131129-0991D218-36C5-44BA-812E-3531DDC277C7 QR25DE engine (except for 2WD with Manual
1. Park the vehicle on a level surface and Transmission for Australia and New Zealand)
apply the parking brake.
2. Start the engine and warm it up until the
engine temperature reaches the normal
operating temperature (approximately 5
minutes).
3. Stop the engine.
4. Wait at least 10 minutes for the engine oil to
drain back to the oil pan.
For YS23DDT/DDTT engine model: Oil filler cap 6. Remove the oil filter cover then the oil
D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8
Oil drain plug filter element.
Oil filter 7. Remove the rubber O-ring from the filter
cover.
8. Wipe the entire oil filter cover with a clean
cloth.
Be sure to remove any old O-ring remaining
on the mounting surface.
9. Apply new engine oil to the O-ring.
Install the new O-ring on the oil filter cap.
10. Insert the oil filter element into the engine
JVM0538X oil filter cover.
11. Screw in the oil filter cover until a slight
resistance is felt, and then tighten the filter
SDI2149 completely.
Oil filter cover tightening torque:
1 Oil filler element 25 N·m
2 O-ring (mounted on the cover) (2.6 kg-m, 18 ft-lb)
3 Oil filter cover/cap
12. Clean and reinstall the drain plug and new
1. Place a large drain pan under the drain plug washer. Securely tighten the drain plug
. with a wrench. Do not use excessive force.
2. Remove the drain plug with a wrench. Drain plug tightening torque:
3. Remove the oil filler cap and completely 50 N·m
drain the oil. (5.1 kg-m, 36.9 ft-lb)
If the oil filter is to be changed, remove and 13. Refill the recommended engine oil and
replace it at this time. quantity. (See “Recommended fluids/lubri-
cants and capacities” (P.9-2).)
CAUTION: 14. Securely install the oil filler cap.
Waste oil must be disposed of properly. 15. Start the engine.
Check your local regulations. 16. Check the drain plug for any sign of
leakage.
4. Remove the front spoiler and the engine
under cover. 17. Dispose of the used oil in the proper
manner. Check your local regulations.
5. Loosen the oil filter cover with a wrench.
18. Check the engine oil level according to the
proper procedure. (See “Checking engine oil
JVM0539X level” (P.8-9).)
8-12 Maintenance and do-it-yourself
PROTECT ENVIRONMENT
D23A131129-56A1B774-53AD-4829-9DF0-63C8F4E96BDF
It is illegal to pollute drains, watercourses and
soil. Use authorized waste collection facilities,
including civil amenity sites and garages pro-
viding facilities for disposal of used oil and used
oil filters. If in doubt, contact your local author-
ity for advice on disposal. JVM0472X
The regulations concerning the pollution of Bleed the air out of the fuel system after
the environment will vary from country to refilling an empty fuel tank by the following
country. JVM0477X procedure:
1. Connect a suitable drain hose to the 1. Operate the priming valve several times
drain plug . until there is a sudden resistance felt in the
pressure, then stop.
2. Place a drain pan under the hose .
2. Crank the engine until the engine starts.
3. Loosen manually the drain plug with 4 to
5 turns and operate the priming valve to
drain the water out of the fuel filter. CAUTION:
4. After draining, close the drain plug manu- Do not crank the engine for more than 30
ally. seconds.
CAUTION: NOTE:
. If the engine does not start, stop cranking
. If the drain plug is tightened excessively, and repeat step 1 of the procedure.
it can be damaged and as a result, fuel . If the engine does not operate smoothly
will leak. after it has started, race it two or three
. Do not use tools to tighten the drain plug. times.
5. Bleed air from the fuel system. For details,
see “Bleeding the fuel system” (P.8-13).
6. Start the engine and make sure there is no
fuel leakage. Correct as required.
CAUTION:
JVM0471X . Do not reuse the iridium-tipped spark
YD25DDTi engine plugs by cleaning or re-gapping.
1. Water pump . Always replace with the recommended
2. Automatic tensioner iridium-tipped spark plugs.
3. Crankshaft pulley
4. Alternator
BRAKES
D23A131129-BE4EF884-FE90-4EB0-8511-BAF5D3759AD5
BRAKE FLUID
D23A131129-91B9BF58-F889-4E42-B748-7B3FA793135D
3. With the foot brake pedal depressed, stop will illuminate. Add fluid up to the MAX line .
the engine. Keep the pedal depressed for WARNING:
If fluid must be added frequently, the system
about 30 seconds. The pedal height should . Use only new fluid from a sealed contain- should be thoroughly checked by your NISSAN
not change. er. Old, inferior, or contaminated fluid dealer.
4. Run the engine for 1 minute without may damage the brake system. The use
depressing the foot brake pedal, then turn of improper fluids can damage the brake
it off. Depress the foot brake pedal several system and affect the vehicle’s stopping
times. The pedal travel distance will de- ability.
crease gradually with each depression as . Clean the filler cap before removing.
the vacuum is released from the booster.
. Brake fluid is poisonous and should be
If the brakes do not operate properly, have the stored carefully in marked containers out
brakes checked by a NISSAN dealer. of the reach of children.
CAUTION:
. Refilling and checking the brake system
should be left to a NISSAN dealer who will
have the necessary brake fluid and tech-
nical knowledge.
. Do not spill the fluid on painted surfaces.
This will damage the paint. If fluid is
spilled, wash with water.
See “Recommended fluids/lubricants and ca-
pacities” (P.9-2) for recommended types of fluid.
JVM0450X
JVM0450X
CleaningD23A131129-FD840453-EA93-4689-8C87-3D85BC14EC01
If the windshield does not become clear after
using the windshield washer or if the wiper
blades chatter when operating the windshield
wipers, wax or other materials may be on the
windshield and/or wiper blades.
Clean the outside of the windshield surface
with a washer solution or mild detergent. Your
windshield is clean if beads do not form when
SDI1718A JVM0451X
rinsing with water.
Clean the blade by wiping it with a cloth soaked
WARNING: WARNING: in a washer solution or a mild detergent. Rinse
Power steering fluid is poisonous and should . Operating the engine with the air cleaner the blade with water. If your windshield is still
be stored carefully in marked containers out filter off can cause you or others to be not clear after cleaning the blades and using
of the reach of children. burned. The air cleaner filter not only the wipers, replace the blades.
cleans the intake air, it also stops flame if
Check the fluid level in the reservoir. The fluid the engine backfires. If the air cleaner
level should be checked in the HOT range ( : filter is not installed and the engine
HOT MAX., : HOT MIN.) at fluid temperatures of backfires, you could be burned. Never
50 to 80°C (122 to 176°F) or in the COLD range drive with the air cleaner filter off. Be
( : COLD MAX., : COLD MIN.) at fluid tempera- cautious working on the engine when the
tures of 0 to 30°C (32 to 86°F). air cleaner filter is off.
If it is necessary to add fluid, use only specified . Never pour fuel into the throttle body or
fluid. Do not overfill. (See “Recommended attempt to start the engine with the air
fluids/lubricants and capacities” (P.9-2) for cleaner removed. Doing so could result in
recommended types of fluid.) serious injury.
To remove the filter, release the lock pins and
pull the unit upward .
The dry paper type filter element may be
cleaned and reused. Replace the air filter
according to the maintenance schedule shown
in a separate maintenance booklet.
When replacing the filter, wipe the inside of the
air cleaner housing and the cover with a damp
cloth.
Replacing
D23A131129-2E138D69-409B-4DC9-A988-26639F137809
SDI2048
SDI2693 CAUTION:
Be careful not to clog the washer nozzle . This . After wiper blade replacement, return the
may cause improper windshield washer opera- wiper arm to its original position. Other-
tion. If the nozzle is clogged, remove any wise the wiper arm or the engine hood
objects with a needle or small pin . Be careful may be scratched and may cause da-
not to damage the nozzle. mage.
. Worn windshield wiper blades can da-
mage the windshield and impair driver
vision.
JVM0452X
WARNING:
Anti-freeze is poisonous and should be
stored carefully in marked containers out of
the reach of children.
Check the fluid level in the reservoir tank and
add fluid if necessary.
If your vehicle is equipped with the low washer
fluid warning (in the vehicle information dis-
play), the warning appears when the washer
fluid is at a low level in the reservoir tank. Add
washer fluid as necessary.
Add a washer solvent to the water for better
cleaning. In the winter season, add windshield
washer antifreeze. Follow the manufacturer’s
instructions for the mixture ratio.
BATTERY
D23A131129-9D14B82B-B588-42BC-9813-56308F54E782
SDI1573
VEHICLE BATTERY
D23A131129-2B8F4112-43D6-4F22-8C12-423FCAA11BF4
WARNING:
Do not operate the vehicle if the fluid in the
battery is low. Low battery fluid can cause a
higher load on the battery which can gen-
erate heat, reduce battery life, and in some
cases lead to an explosion.
CheckingD23A131129-3D0153AC-ACD1-4AEC-92F6-233F842AF00F
battery fluid level above the cell; the condition indicates OK . There is danger of explosion if lithium
and the condition needs more to be battery is incorrectly replaced. Replace
added. only with the same or equivalent type.
3. Replace and tighten the cell plugs. . Do not expose the battery to excessive
. Vehicles operated in high temperatures or heat such as sunshine, fire, etc.
under severe conditions require frequent
checks of the battery fluid level.
. Keep the battery surface clean and dry. Any
corrosion should be cleared with a firmly
wrung out moist cloth.
. Make certain the terminal connections are
clean and securely tightened.
DI0137MD . If the vehicle is not to be used for more
than 30 days, disconnect the negative (−)
battery terminal cable to prevent battery
discharge.
Jump starting
D23A131129-BE336D38-925A-44F9-B19D-862D45C27323
If jump starting is necessary, see “Jump start-
ing” (P.6-7). If the engine does not start by jump
starting or the battery does not charge, the
battery may have to be replaced. Contact a
NISSAN dealer for replacing the battery.
. Do not touch the internal circuit and . Do not expose the battery to excessive 3. Replace the battery with a new one.
electric terminals as doing so could heat such as sunshine, fire, etc. . Recommended battery: CR2025 or
cause a malfunction. equivalent
. Make sure that the + side faces the . Do not touch the internal circuit and
bottom of the case . electric terminals as doing so could
3. Close the lid and install the screw securely. cause a malfunction.
4. Operate the buttons to check its operation. . Make sure that the + side faces the
See a NISSAN dealer if you need assistance for bottom of the case.
replacement.
FCC Notice:
This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC
Rules. Operation is subject to the following
two conditions: (1) this device may not cause
harmful interference, and (2) this device must
accept any interference received, including
interference that may cause undesired op-
eration.
Note: Changes or modifications not expressly
approved by the party responsible for com- SDI2452
pliance could void the user’s authority to
operate the equipment. 4. Align the tips of the upper and lower parts
, and then push them together until it is
INTELLIGENT KEY BATTERY (if equipped)
D23A131129-B98195EA-CA41-4494-8F50-3F7C436E3D9D securely closed .
Battery replacement 5. Operate the buttons to check its operation.
D23A131129-E450EFA1-BF09-42BF-8DAC-08685BC684C2
See a NISSAN dealer if you need assistance for
CAUTION: replacement.
SDI2451
. Be careful not to allow children to swal- FCC Notice:
low the battery and removed parts. To replace the battery: This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC
. An improperly disposed battery can harm 1. Release the lock knob at the back of the Rules. Operation is subject to the following
the environment. Always confirm local Intelligent Key and remove the mechanical two conditions: (1) this device may not cause
regulations for battery disposal. key. harmful interference, and (2) this device must
accept any interference received, including
. When changing batteries, do not let dust 2. Insert a small screwdriver into the slit of the interference that may cause undesired op-
or oil get on the components. corner and twist it to separate the upper eration.
. There is danger of explosion if lithium part from the lower part. Use a cloth to
protect the casing. Note: Changes or modifications not expressly
battery is incorrectly replaced. Replace approved by the party responsible for com-
only with the same or equivalent type. pliance could void the user’s authority to
operate the equipment.
Maintenance and do-it-yourself 8-23
CAUTION:
. Do not ground accessories directly to the
battery terminal. Doing so will bypass the
variable voltage control system and the
vehicle battery may not charge comple-
tely.
SDI1753
. Use electrical accessories with the engine
running to avoid discharging the vehicle JVM0453X 6. Remove the fuse using the fuse puller
battery. located in the passenger compartment
fuse box.
CAUTION:
7. If the fuse is open , replace it with a new
Never use a fuse of a higher or lower fuse .
amperage rating than that specified on the If the new fuse also opens, after installing,
fuse box cover. This could damage the have the electrical system checked, and if
electrical system or cause a fire. necessary repaired, by a NISSAN dealer.
The location and the amperage rating of fuses Fusible links
are shown on the backside of the fuse box lid. D23A131129-A3F371BD-6E7F-460C-BBE8-B484EB711BAA
If any electrical equipment does not operate
The number of fuses may vary depending on and the fuses are in good condition, check the
the features equipped to the vehicle. fusible links. If any of these fusible links are
If any electrical equipment does not operate, melted, replace only with genuine NISSAN
check for an open fuse. parts.
1. Be sure the ignition switch is in the “OFF” or
“LOCK” position.
2. Be sure the headlight switch is in the “OFF”
position.
3. Open the engine hood.
4. Remove the fuse/fusible link cover by
pushing the tab.
5. Locate the fuse which needs to be re-
placed.
PASSENGER COMPARTMENT 1. Be sure the ignition switch is in the “OFF” Extended storage fuse switch (if
D23A131129-9F4C187C-98E0-47F4-AC30-6B2F92D00A5B
position. equipped)
D23A131129-E2FC7D10-F4B1-4B15-ABE6-4C8A3FE8A432
2. Be sure the headlight switch is in the “OFF”
position.
3. Open the glove box.
4. Hold the glove box lid and pull it up to
release the hinges located on the under-
side of the glove box.
5. Carefully release the left and right stoppers
and remove the glove box.
6. Locate the fuse that needs to be replaced.
JVM0473X 7. Remove the fuse using the fuse puller .
JVM0462X
JVM0461X
LIGHTS
D23A131129-E98CB186-43DE-42CE-8114-D9E8A87B06F9
How to remove the extended storage fuse HEADLIGHTS Replacing halogen headlight bulb
D23A131129-40AA33AE-8008-4E82-9C91-ACF0DDE05F02
D23A131129-2C489B1A-2225-4AEE-88D8-6F2B8F7820FE
switch: D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8 Fog may temporarily form inside the lens of the
1. To remove the extended storage fuse exterior lights in the rain or in a car wash. A
switch, be sure the ignition switch is in the temperature difference between the inside and
“OFF” or “LOCK” position. the outside of the lens causes the fog. This is
2. Be sure the headlight switch is in the “OFF” not a malfunction. If large drops of water
position. collect inside the lens, contact a NISSAN dealer.
3. Remove the fuse box cover. Replacing LED headlight
D23A131129-08192005-5F1A-40A5-8F0D-A86C05110EAD
4. Pinch the locking tabs found on each If replacement is required, contact a NISSAN
side of the storage fuse switch. dealer.
5. Pull the extended storage fuse switch
straight out from the fuse box .
JVM0470X
gen) bulbs. They can be replaced from inside EXTERIOR LIGHTS INTERIORD23A131129-41A861EB-5A1B-49A4-870F-83BAD8CB1E27
LIGHTS
D23A131129-4A1154A6-C2AF-406B-BB25-CDE38FCA506D
the engine compartment without removing the
headlight assembly. Item Wattage (W) Item Wattage (W)
Front turn signal 21 Map light (LED type)* LED
CAUTION: Clearance light (Halogen 5 Map light (bulb type) 5
High-pressure halogen gas is sealed inside headlight models) Room light (if equipped) 10
the bulb. The bulb may break if the glass Clearance light and daytime LED Rear personal light (if LED
envelope is scratched or the bulb is dropped. running light (LED headlight equipped)
models)*
1. Disconnect the battery negative cable. Step light (if equipped) 3.4
Front fog light (if equipped) 55
2. Disconnect the electrical connector from Vanity mirror light (if 1.8
the rear end of the bulb. Daytime running light (if 19 equipped)
equipped for halogen
3. Pull off the rubber cap . headlight models) *: See a NISSAN dealer for replacement.
4. Push and turn the retaining pin to Side turn signal light* (on LED
loosen it. the outside rearview mirror)
5. Remove the headlight bulb. Do not shake (if equipped)
or rotate the bulb when removing it. Side turn signal light (on the 5
6. Install the new bulb in the reverse order of front fender) (if equipped)
removal.
Rear combination light
CAUTION: Turn signal 21
Stop/tail 21/5
. When handling the bulb, do not touch the
Reverse 21
glass envelope.
. Use the same number and wattage as Rear fog light (if 21
originally installed: equipped)
License plate light 5
Halogen headlight model High-mounted stop light (if
High/low beam bulb: 60W/55W (H4) LED
equipped)*
. Do not leave the bulb out of the headlight Cargo light (if equipped)* LED
reflector for a long period of time as dust,
*: See a NISSAN dealer for replacement.
moisture and smoke may enter the head-
light body and affect the performance of
the headlight.
Aiming adjustment is not necessary if only the
bulbs are replaced. When aiming adjustment is
necessary, contact a NISSAN dealer.
JVM0640X
Replacement procedures Removal of the front grille before replacing 2. Install the turn fasteners on the front grille.
D23A131129-75FDF35A-40F7-4669-B637-489609E43D8F
bulbs: D23A131129-98445435-9C30-4853-A60E-A898A867D4A8 3. Lock the turn fasteners by rotating 45
degrees.
4. Push the grille into the vehicle to install it.
JVM0455X
SDI2306
: REMOVE JVM0457X
: INSTALL Clearance light (bulb type)
All other lights are either type A, B, C, D or E.
When replacing a bulb, first remove the lens
and/or cover.
JVM0152X
JVM0458X SDI1688
Front fog light (if equipped) or daytime running light Side turn signal light (on the front fender) (if
(if equipped) equipped)
JVM0463X
Rear combination light (turn signal, stop and reverse
or rear fog (if equipped)) (models with truck box)
: Stop/tail light
: Turn signal light
SDI2391
Front map light (bulb type)
JVM0540X
Rear combination light (turn signal, stop and re-
verse) (models without truck box)
: Stop/tail light
: Turn signal light
: Reverse light
SDI1845
JVM0464X Room light (if equipped)
License plate light
JVM0553X
Step light (if equipped)
Four-Wheel Drive (4WD) model wheels and not on the front wheels. . Do not include the spare tire in tire
D23A131129-5A000B3B-9C45-450E-B069-99CE03BFEA0C
Never install tire chains on a temporary-use rotation.
CAUTION: spare tire (if equipped). . Incorrect tire selection, fitting, care or
Do not drive with tire chains on paved roads maintenance can affect vehicle safety
. Always use tires of the same type, size, with risk of accident and injury. If in
brand, construction (bias, bias-belted or which are clear of snow. Driving with chains in
such conditions can cause damage to the doubt, consult a NISSAN dealer or the tire
radial), and tread pattern on all four manufacturer.
wheels. Failure to do so may result in a various mechanisms of the vehicle due to some
circumference difference between tires overstress.
on the front and rear axles which will
TIRE WEAR AND DAMAGE
D23A131129-30CC6DEB-1C96-46A9-841D-67EBB9AFB121
cause excessive tire wear and may da-
TIRE ROTATION
D23A131129-ACE755DD-E4BB-46A4-9F62-496D13BFF28A
mage the transmission, transfer case and
differential gears.
. ONLY use spare tires specified for the
4WD model.
If excessive tire wear is found, it is recom-
mended that all four tires be replaced with tires
of the same size, brand, construction and tread
pattern. The tire pressure and wheel alignment
should also be checked and corrected as
necessary. Contact a NISSAN dealer. SDI1663
SDI1662
TIRE CHAINS
D23A131129-F2CF20EA-51D4-4282-AF61-8B4AA00858B3 : Wear indicator
Use of tire chains may be prohibited according NISSAN recommends that tires be rotated : Wear indicator location marks. The loca-
to location. Check the local laws before instal- every 5,000 km (3,000 miles) for Four-Wheel tions are shown by “ ”, “TWI”, etc.
ling tire chains. When installing tire chains, Drive (4WD) or every 10,000 km (6,000 miles) for depending on tire types.
make sure that they are of proper size for the Two-Wheel Drive (2WD) model. However, the
Tires should be periodically inspected for wear,
tires on your vehicle and are installed accord- timing for tire rotation may vary according to
cracking, bulging or objects caught in the
ing to the chain manufacturer’s instructions. your driving habits and the road surface
tread. If excessive wear, cracks, bulging or deep
Use chain tensioners when recommended by conditions. (See “Flat tire” (P.6-2) for the tire
cuts are found, the tire should be replaced
the tire chain manufacturer to ensure a tight fit. replacement.)
immediately.
Loose end links of the tire chains must be The original tires have a built-in tread wear
secured or removed to prevent the possibility WARNING:
indicator. When the wear indicator is visible, the
of whipping action damage to the fenders or tire should be replaced.
. After rotating the tires, adjust the tire
underbody. If possible, avoid fully loading your
pressure. Improper service of a spare tire may result in
vehicle when using tire chains. In addition, drive
at a reduced speed. Otherwise, your vehicle . Retighten the wheel nuts when the vehi- serious personal injury. If it is necessary to
may be damaged and/or vehicle handling and cle has been driven for 1,000 km (600 repair the spare tire, contact a NISSAN dealer.
performance may be adversely affected. miles) (also in cases of a flat tire, etc.).
Tire chains must be installed only on the rear
Maintenance and do-it-yourself 8-33
TIRE AGE WHEEL BALANCE . Avoid sharp turns and abrupt braking
D23A131129-228B8BE1-7F61-4781-9F67-E03ABE1C166F D23A131129-0201BE0C-9A67-422C-A87B-6E890267D904
while driving.
Never use a tire over six years old, regardless of Unbalanced wheels may affect vehicle handling
whether it has been used or not. and tire life. Even with regular use, wheels can . Periodically check the spare tire inflation
get out of balance. Therefore, they should be pressure. See the tire placard on your
Tires degrade with age as well as with the
balanced as required. vehicle for the recommended tire infla-
vehicle usage. Have your tires checked and
tion pressure.
balanced often by a repair shop or, if you prefer,
a NISSAN dealer.
SPARE TIRE GUID-D2B7E6FC-9E87-4C2E-915B-26C37C0445AB . Do not drive your vehicle at speeds faster
The spare tire supplied with your vehicle varies than 80 km/h (50 MPH).
CHANGING TIRES AND WHEELS
D23A131129-AE234277-C1BE-46F1-8E0D-ED221CBB7A84
depending on the model. See “Tires and . Do not use tire chains on a spare tire. Tire
wheels” (P.9-7) for applicable spare tire. chains will not fit properly on the spare
WARNING: tire and may cause damage to the
Temporary-use spare tire (if equipped)
GUID-117C9DB3-18E5-4DF0-8AD2-C1D6C95B5C09 vehicle.
Do not install a deformed wheel or tire even if
it has been repaired. Such wheels or tires . When driving on roads covered with snow
could have structural damage and could fail or ice, the spare tire should be used on
without warning. the front wheel and the original tire used
on the rear wheels (drive wheels). Use tire
When replacing a tire, use the same size, speed chains only on the rear two original tires.
rating and load carrying capacity as originally . Because the spare tire is smaller than the
equipped. (See “Tires and wheels” (P.9-7) for original tire, ground clearance is reduced.
recommended types and sizes of tires and To avoid damage to the vehicle do not
wheels.) The use of tires other than those drive over obstacles. Also do not drive the
recommended or the mixed use of tires of vehicle through an automatic car wash
different brands, construction (bias, bias- since it may get caught.
belted, or radial), or tread patterns can ad- SDI1912
versely affect the ride, braking, handling, Spare tire label . Do not use the spare tire on other
ground clearance, body-to-tire clearance, snow A temporary-use spare tire (different size from vehicles.
chain clearance, speedometer calibration, the original tire) is supplied with your vehicle. . Do not use more than one spare tire at
headlight aim and bumper height. Some of Observe the following precautions if the spare the same time.
these effects may lead to accidents and could tire must be used, otherwise your vehicle could
result in serious personal injury. be damaged or involved in an accident. Conventional spare tire (if equipped)
GUID-9A9120BE-C58A-43E3-9910-A247CC6DE520
If the wheels are changed for any reason, A standard tire (the same size as the road
always replace with wheels which have the CAUTION: wheels) is supplied with your vehicle.
same offset dimension. Wheels of a different
offset could cause early tire wear, possibly . The spare tire should be used only for
degraded vehicle handling characteristics emergency. It should be replaced by the
and/or interference with the brake discs/ standard tire at the first opportunity.
drums. Such interference can lead to de- . Drive carefully while the spare tire is
creased braking efficiency and/or early brake installed.
pad/shoe wear.
9 Technical information
Recommended fluids/lubricants and capacities ................ .... 9-2 Engine serial number ...................................................................
.... 9-15
Fuel information .....................................................................................
.... 9-4 Tire placard ..........................................................................................
.... 9-15
Recommended SAE viscosity number (except for Air conditioner specification label .....................................
.... 9-15
YS23DDT/DDTT engine model) .................................................
.... 9-4 Installation of an RF-transmitter ..................................................
.... 9-16
Air conditioner system refrigerant and lubricant ....... .... 9-5 Radio approval number and information ............................. .... 9-16
Engine ....................................................................................................................
.... 9-6 For Thailand ........................................................................................
.... 9-16
Tires and wheels ...........................................................................................
.... 9-7 For Indonesia ......................................................................................
.... 9-16
Dimensions ........................................................................................................
.... 9-8 For Vietnam .........................................................................................
.... 9-17
When travelling or registering in another country ......... .... 9-14 For Western Samoa .......................................................................
.... 9-17
Vehicle identification ...............................................................................
.... 9-14 For Pakistan .........................................................................................
.... 9-17
Vehicle identification label ..........................................................
.... 9-14 For Surinam .........................................................................................
.... 9-17
Vehicle Identification Number (VIN) label For Jamaica .........................................................................................
.... 9-18
(if equipped) ............................................................................................
.... 9-14 For Tahiti, Montserrat and New Caledonia ................ .... 9-18
Vehicle Identification Number (VIN) ..................................... .... 9-14 For South Africa ...............................................................................
.... 9-21
RECOMMENDED FLUIDS/
LUBRICANTS AND CAPACITIES
D23A131129-CEAE5A50-CAB8-4BA6-8D4B-FCC3B1B24D70
The following are approximate capacities. The actual refill quantities may be slightly different. When refilling, follow the procedures instructed in the “8.
Maintenance and do-it-yourself” section to determine the proper refill capacity.
Capacity (approximate)
Fluid type Metric US Imperial Recommended Fluids/Lubricants
Measure Measure Measure
Fuel 80 L 21-1/8 gal 17-5/8 gal · See “Fuel information” (P.9-4).
Engine oil*1 QR25DE With oil filter change 4.7 L 5 qt 4-1/8 qt · Genuine “NISSAN Motor Oil 0W-20 SN” is recommended.
Drain and refill · If the above motor oil is not available, use “NISSAN Motor Oil” or equivalent that
*1
: For additional in- matches the following grade and viscosity.
formation, see Without oil filter change 4.4 L 4-75/8 qt 3-7/8 qt · Oil grade: API SM or SN, ILSAC GF-4 or GF-5
“Changing engine oil · SAE Viscosity: See “Recommended SAE viscosity number (except for
and oil filter” (P.8-10). YS23DDT/DDTT engine model)” (P.9-4).
YD25DDTi With oil filter change 5.3 L 5-5/8 qt 4-5/8 qt · Genuine “NISSAN Motor Oil 5W-30 CF-4 or B1” is recommended.
· If the above motor oil is not available, use “NISSAN Motor Oil” or equivalent that
matches the following grade and viscosity.
Without oil filter change 4.8 L 5-1/8 qt 4-1/4 qt · Oil grade:
– API CF-4*2
– ACEA B1, B3, B4 or B5
*2
: Never use API CG-4.
Capacity (approximate)
Fluid type Metric US Imperial Recommended Fluids/Lubricants
Measure Measure Measure
Transfer fluid 1.5 L 1-5/8 qt 1-3/8 qt · Genuine NISSAN ATF D3M
· Using fluid other than Genuine NISSAN ATF D3M may cause deterioration in
driveability and transfer durability, and may damage the transfer, which is not
covered by the warranty.
Power steering fluid Refill to the proper fluid level · Genuine NISSAN PSF or equivalent
according to the instructions in · DEXRONTM VI type ATF may also be used.
Brake and clutch fluid the “8. Maintenance and do-it- · Genuine NISSAN Brake Fluid or equivalent DOT3 or DOT4
yourself” section. · Never mix different types of fluids (DOT3 and DOT4).
Differential gear oil Front 0.85 L 7/8 qt 3/4 qt · Genuine NISSAN Differential Oil Hypoid Super GL-5 80W-90 (mineral oil)
· NISSAN recommends using Genuine NISSAN Differential Oil Hypoid Super GL-5
80W-90 ONLY in NISSAN final drive. Do not mix with other fluids. Using fluids
that are not equivalent to Genuine NISSAN Differential Oil Hypoid Super GL-5
80W-90 may damage the final drive. Damage caused by the use of fluids other
than as recommended is not covered under the warranty.
Rear 2.85 L 3 qt 2-1/2 qt · Genuine NISSAN Differential Oil Hypoid Super-S GL-5 synthetic 75W-90
· NISSAN recommends using Genuine NISSAN Differential Oil Hypoid Super-S GL-5
synthetic 75W-90 ONLY in NISSAN final drive. Do not mix with other fluids. Using
fluids that are not equivalent to Genuine NISSAN Differential Oil Hypoid Super-S
GL-5 synthetic 75W-90 may damage the final drive. Damage caused by the use
of fluids other than as recommended is not covered under the warranty.
Multi-purpose grease - - - · NLGI No. 2 (Lithium soap base)
Air conditioner system refrigerant - - - · HFC-134a (R-134a)
Air conditioner system lubricants - - - · NISSAN A/C System Oil Type S or equivalent
FUEL INFORMATION
D23A131129-98205A26-3AD9-4B1F-8857-A48DC4601D72 CAUTION: RECOMMENDED SAE VISCOSITY NUM-
BER (except for YS23DDT/DDTT engine
Gasoline engine (model with three-way . Do not use home heating oil, gasoline or model) D23A131129-881EDE31-CA7D-44C7-9994-FF3EC887607B
catalyst) GUID-66BE0FEB-31BF-4066-9B61-1F1698E4C255
other alternate fuels in your diesel en-
gine. The use of those or adding those to Gasoline engine oil
GUID-C453985D-4614-4628-A474-C85EEC7078B5
CAUTION: diesel fuel can cause engine damage.
0W-20 is preferable.
Do not use leaded gasoline. Using leaded . Do not use summer fuel at temperatures If 0W-20 is not available, select the viscosity,
gasoline will damage the three-way catalyst. below −7°C (20°F). The cold temperatures from the chart below, that is suitable for the
will cause wax to form in the fuel. As a outside temperature range.
Use UNLEADED REGULAR gasoline with an result, it may prevent the engine from
octane rating of at least 91 (RON). running smoothly.
For Thailand: Use UNLEADED REGULAR gasoline
or gasohol (up to E10*) with an octane rating of
at least 91 (RON).
*: Gasohol is alcohol blended gasoline. For
example, “E10” is a mixture of approximately
10% fuel ethanol and 90% unleaded gasoline.
Diesel engine*
D23A131129-97A49324-500D-48C4-ABCC-B5F9B3159362
YD25DDTi engine:
Diesel fuel above 50 cetane must be used.
YS23DDT/DDTT engine:
Diesel fuel above 50 cetane and with a max-
imum of 10 ppm of sulfur (EN590) must be used.
(except for South Africa)
Diesel fuel above 50 cetane and with a max-
imum of 50 ppm of sulfur (EN590) must be
used. (for South Africa)
* If two types of diesel fuel are available, use summer
or winter fuel properly according to the following
temperature conditions.
. Above −7°C (20°F) ... Summer type diesel
fuel. STI0732
. Below −7°C (20°F) ... Winter type diesel fuel.
CAUTION:
Use of any other refrigerants or lubricants
will cause severe damage, and you may need
to replace your vehicle’s entire air condi-
tioner system.
The release of refrigerants into the atmosphere
is prohibited in many countries and regions.
The refrigerant HFC-134a (R-134a) in your
vehicle will not harm the Earth’s ozone layer.
However, it may contribute in a small part to
the global warming effect. NISSAN recom-
mends that the refrigerant be appropriately
recovered and recycled. Contact a NISSAN
dealer when servicing the air conditioner
system.
STI0387B
ENGINE
D23A131129-0DBB8908-01C5-4F91-8E53-8E62D232FE7C
DIMENSIONS
D23A131129-B71682FB-3F2F-4D32-B390-D729996F92A4
mm (in)
Destination Thailand (except for Sportech models)
Body type Single Cab King Cab Double Cab
Models without bed and 5,120 (201.6)
5,120 (201.6) 5,210 (205.1)
rear bumper
Models with bed and 5,230 (205.9)
Overall length 5,240 (206.3) 5,230 (205.9)
without rear bumper
Models with bed and rear 5,255 (206.9)
5,330 (209.8) 5,255 (206.9)
bumper
Narrow body models 1,790 (70.5) 1,790 (70.5) 1,790 (70.5)
Overall width
Wide body models — 1,850 (72.8) 1,850 (72.8)
1,720 (67.7)*2*4*5 1,750 (68.9)*2*4*5
Two-Wheel Drive (2WD ) 1,725 (67.9)*1*4*5 1,745 (68.7)*2*4*6 1,775 (69.9)*2*4*6
models 1,715 (67.5)*2*4*5 1,755 (69.1)*2*4*7 1,785 (70.3)*2*4*7
Overall height 1,755 (69.1)*2*4*8 1,820 (71.7)*2*3*8
Four-Wheel Drive (4WD) 1,760 (69.3)*2*4*7 1,810 (71.3)*2*4*7
1,730 (68.1)*1*4*5 1,840 (72.4)*2*3*8
models 1,760 (69.3)*2*4*8
1,560 (61.4)*5 1,560 (61.4)*5
Front tread 1,560 (61.4)*5 1,550 (61.0)*6 1,550 (61.0)*6
1,570 (61.8)*7 1,570 (61.8)*7*8
1,560 (61.4)*5 1,560 (61.4)*5
Rear tread 1,560 (61.4)*5 1,550 (61.0)*6 1,550 (61.0)*6
1,570 (61.8)*7 1,570 (61.8)*7*8
Wheelbase 3,150 (124.0) 3,150 (124.0) 3,150 (124.0)
mm (in)
Destination Australia (except for N-SPORT models) and New Zealand
Body type Single Cab King Cab Double Cab
Models without bed and 5,120 (201.6)
5,120 (201.6) 5,210 (205.1)
rear bumper
Models with bed and 5,230 (205.9)
Overall length 5,240 (206.3) 5,230 (205.9)
without rear bumper
Models with bed and rear 5,255 (206.9)
5,330 (209.8) 5,255 (206.9)
bumper
Narrow body models 1,790 (70.5) 1,790 (70.5) 1,790 (70.5)
Overall width
Wide body models — 1,850 (72.8) 1,850 (72.8)
1,760 (69.3)*2*3
Two-Wheel Drive (2WD) 1,720 (67.7)*2*3 1,785 (70.3)*2*4
1,750 (68.9)*2*4 1,815 (71.5)*2*5
models 1,745 (68.7)*2*4
Overall height 1,845 (72.6)*1*6
1,800 (70.9)*2*4
Four-Wheel Drive (4WD) 1,735 (68.3)*2*3 1,770 (69.7)*2*4 1,825 (71.9)*2*5
models 1,765 (69.5)*2*4 1780 (70.1)*2*5*6 1,855 (73.0)*1*6
1,560 (61.4)*3
1,560 (61.4)*3 1,550 (61.0)*4 1,550 (61.0)*4
Front tread
1,550 (61.0)*4 1,570 (61.8)*5*6 1,570 (61.8)*5*6
1,560 (61.4)*3
1,560 (61.4)*3 1,550 (61.0)*4 1,550 (61.0)*4
Rear tread
1,550 (61.0)*4 1,570 (61.8)*5*6 1,570 (61.8)*5*6
Wheelbase 3,150 (124.0) 3,150 (124.0) 3,150 (124.0)
mm (in)
Philippines
Destination (except for SPORT EDI- Indonesia Vietnam and Myanmar Laos and Cambodia
TION models)
Body type Double Cab Double Cab Double Cab Double Cab
Models without bed and —
5,120 (201.6) — —
rear bumper
Overall length Models without rear —
5,230 (205.9) — —
bumper
Models with rear bumper 5,255 (206.9) 5,255 (206.9) 5,255 (206.9) 5,255 (206.9)
Narrow body models 1,790 (70.5) — 1,790 (70.5) 1,790 (70.5)
Overall width
Wide body models 1,850 (72.8) 1,850 (72.8) 1,850 (72.8) 1,850 (72.8)
1,760 (69.3)*2*3 1,785 (70.3)*2*4
Two-Wheel Drive (2WD) 1,780 (70.1)*2*4
1,795 (70.7)*2*5 — 1,795 (70.7)*2*5
models 1,825 (71.9)*1*6
Overall height 1,825 (71.9)*1*6
Four-Wheel Drive (4WD) 1,810 (71.3)*2*5 1,810 (71.3)*2*5 1,810 (71.3)*2*6 1,810 (71.3)*2*6
models 1,840 (72.4)*1*6 1,840 (72.4)*1*6 1,840 (72.4)*1*6
1,560 (61.4)*3 1,550 (61.0)*4 1,550 (61.0)*4
Front tread 1,570 (61.8)*5*6 1,570 (61.8)*5*6
1,570 (61.8)*5*6 1,570 (61.8)*6
1,560 (61.4)*3 1,550 (61.0)*4 1,550 (61.0)*4
Rear tread 1,570 (61.8)*5*6 1,570 (61.8)*5*6
1,570 (61.8)*5*6 1,570 (61.8)*6
Wheelbase 3,150 (124.0) 3,150 (124.0) 3,150 (124.0) 3,150 (124.0)
mm (in)
Destination Brunei Type A*8 Type B*9 Type C*10
Body type Double Cab Single Cab Double Cab Double Cab Double Cab
Models without 5,230 (205.9)
— — — —
rear bumper
Overall length
Models with 5,255 (206.9)
5,255 (206.9) 5,330 (209.8) 5,255 (206.9) 5,255 (206.9)
rear bumper
Narrow body 1,790 (70.5)
— 1,790 (70.5) — 1,790 (70.5)
models
Overall width
Wide body 1,850 (72.8)
1,850 (72.8) — 1,850 (72.8) 1,850 (72.8)
models
Two-Wheel
1,785 (70.3)*1*4*5 —
Drive (2WD) — 1,760 (69.3)*1*4*5 1,780 (70.1)*2*4*5
1,795 (70.7)*2*4*6
models
Overall height
Four-Wheel 1,800 (70.9)*2*4*5
1,810 (71.3)*2*4*6 1,800 (70.9)*2*4*5 1,810 (71.3)*2*4*6
Drive (4WD) 1,810 (71.3)*2*4*6*7 —
1,840 (72.4)*2*3*6 1,810 (71.3)*2*4*6 1,840 (72.4)*2*3*7
models
1,550 (61.0)*5 1,550 (61.0)*5 1,550 (61.0)*5
Front tread 1,570 (61.8)*6*7 1,550 (61.0)*5 1,570 (61.8)*6*7
1,570 (61.8)*6 1,570 (61.8)*6
1,550 (61.0)*5 1,550 (61.0)*5 1,550 (61.0)*5
Rear tread 1,570 (61.8)*6*7 1,550 (61.0)*5 1,570 (61.8)*6*7
1,570 (61.8)*6 1,570 (61.8)*6
Wheelbase 3,150 (124.0) 3,150 (124.0) 3,150 (124.0) 3,150 (124.0) 3,150 (124.0)
mm (in)
South Africa and Sub Sahar-
Destination Malaysia an Africa
Body type Single Cab Double Cab Double Cab
Models with bed and rear 5,261 (207.1)
Overall length 5,235 (206.0) 5,255 (206.9)
bumper
Narrow body models 1,790 (70.5) — —
Overall width
Wide body models — 1,850 (72.8) 1,850 (72.8)
Two-Wheel Drive (2WD) 1,815 (71.5)*2*5
— — 1,850 (72.8)*3*4
models
Overall height 1,800 (70.9)*1
Four-Wheel Drive (4WD) 1,830 (72.0)*2*5
1,775 (69.9) 1,810 (71.3)*2 1,865 (73.4)*3*4
models
1,840 (72.4)*3
1,550 (61.0)*1 1,570 (61.8)
Front tread 1,550 (61.0)
1,570 (61.8)*2*3
1,550 (61.0)*1 1,570 (61.8)
Rear tread 1,550 (61.0)
1,570 (61.8)*2*3
Wheelbase 3,150 (124.0) 3,150 (124.0) 3,150 (124.0)
mm (in)
Philippines
Thailand Australia (for SPORT EDITION
Destination
(for Sportech models) (for N-SPORT models) models)
Body type King Cab Double Cab Double Cab Double Cab
Overall length 5,255 (206.9) 5,260 (207.1) 5,260 (207.1) 5,260 (207.1)
Overall width 1,850 (72.8) 1,850 (72.8) 1,850 (72.8) 1,850 (72.8)
Two-Wheel Drive 1,825 (71.9)
1,755 (69.1) 1,785 (70.3) —
(2WD) models
Overall height
Four-Wheel Drive 1,840 (72.4)
— 1,790 (70.5) 1,810 (71.3)
(4WD) models
Front tread 1,570 (61.8) 1,570 (61.8) 1,570 (61.8) 1,570 (61.8)
Rear tread 1,570 (61.8) 1,570 (61.8) 1,570 (61.8) 1,570 (61.8)
JVT0367X
YS23DDT/DDTT engine
JVT0370X
The number is stamped on the engine as
QR25DE engine shown. JVT0274X
STI0300A
YD25DDTi engine
STI0435
JVT0375X
JVT0378X
JVT0376X
Manufacturer:
ALPS ELECTRIC CO., LTD.
JVT0195X Brand:
NISSAN
. Remote keyless entry system (if equipped) Model:
. Intelligent Key system (if equipped) TWB1G662
. NISSAN Anti-Theft System (NATS) (if JVT0381X Country of manufacture:
equipped) China
. Remote keyless entry system (if equipped)
. Intelligent Key system (if equipped)
. NISSAN Anti-Theft System (NATS) (if
equipped)
Manufacturer:
ALPS ELECTRIC CO., LTD.
Approved for use in Jamaica SMA EI:
TWC1G135
NSY0105
NSY0105
JVT0141X JVT0185X
JVT0494X
JVT0495X JVT0496X
JVT0094X
MEMO
10 Index
A B Child restraint installation using
three-point type seat belt ....................................
... 1-19
ABS (Anti-lock Braking System) ....................... ... 5-35 Battery.......................................................................
... 8-4, 8-21 Child restraint installation using
Air bag system Battery saver system.......................... ... 2-35, 2-49 two-point type seat belt........................................
... 1-23
Supplemental curtain side-impact air Intelligent Key battery ......................................
... 8-23 Child restraints ..............................................................
... 1-13
bag system .................................................
... 1-25, 1-31 Intelligent Key battery replacement ..... ... 8-23 Child safety.......................................................................
... 1-10
Supplemental driver’s knee air Remote controller battery............................. ... 8-22 Child safety rear door lock ......................................
... 3-5
bag system .................................................
... 1-25, 1-31 Remote controller Chimes, Audible reminders .................................. ... 2-19
Supplemental front-impact air battery replacement ..........................................
... 8-22 Circuit breaker, Fusible link .................................
... 8-24
bag system .................................................
... 1-25, 1-31 Variable voltage control system .............. ... 8-24 Cleaning exterior and interior ................... ... 7-2, 7-4
Supplemental side-impact air Bleeding the fuel system.......................................
... 8-13 Clock ......................................................................................
... 2-30
bag system .................................................
... 1-25, 1-31 Bluetooth® audio player operation ............... ... 4-62 Clutch
Air conditioner ...............................................................
... 4-22 Bluetooth® Hands-Free Clutch fluid.................................................................
... 8-17
Air conditioner operation...............................
... 4-21 Phone System ..................................
... 4-77, 4-83, 4-87 Cockpit .....................................................................................
... 2-3
Air conditioner service......................................
... 4-30 Brake Cold weather driving ................................................
... 5-37
Air conditioner specification label........... ... 9-15 Anti-lock Braking System (ABS) ................ ... 5-35 Compass.............................................................................
... 2-11
Air conditioning system refrigerant Brake assist ...............................................................
... 5-35 Console box .....................................................................
... 2-44
and lubricant recommendations ............. ... 4-30 Brake booster..........................................................
... 8-15 Console light ...................................................................
... 2-47
Antenna...............................................................................
... 4-76 Brake fluid ..................................................................
... 8-16 Coolant
Anti-lock Braking System (ABS) ....................... ... 5-35 Brake system ...........................................................
... 5-35 Changing engine coolant ................................. ... 8-8
Anti-lock braking system (ABS) Parking brake check ..........................................
... 8-15 Checking engine coolant level...................... ... 8-8
warning light ...................................................................
... 2-14 Parking brake operation.................................... 5-37 Corrosion protection ....................................................
... 7-5
Appearance care Warning light ............................................................
... 2-14 Cruise control .................................................................
... 5-26
Exterior appearance care .................................
... 7-2 Break-in schedule ...........................................................
... 5-3 Cup holders......................................................................
... 2-44
Interior appearance care...................................
... 7-4 Brightness control
Around View Monitor ...............................................
... 4-13 Instrument panel ..................................................
... 2-10 D
Audible reminders.......................................................
... 2-19 Bulb check/instrument panel............................ ... 2-14
Audio operation precautions ............................. ... 4-31 Bulb replacement .............................................
... 8-2, 8-26 Daytime running light system........................... ... 2-34
Audio system ..................................................................
... 4-31 Defogger switch ...........................................................
... 2-38
Audio control steering switch .................... ... 4-75 C Diesel Particulate Filter (DPF) .................................
... 5-5
FM-AM radio with compact disc (CD) Dimensions ...........................................................................
... 9-8
player........ 4-39, 4-44, 4-51, 4-57, 4-63, 4-69 C-Channel system ......................................................
... 3-20 Display
Automatic Card holder.......................................................................
... 2-46 Vehicle information display
Automatic sunroof ..............................................
... 2-41 Cargo light switch.......................................................
... 2-37 (models with color display)........................... ... 2-20
Automatic air conditioner ....................................
... 4-29 Catalytic converter, Three way catalyst ....... ... 5-4 Vehicle information display
Auxiliary input jack .......................
... 4-43, 4-62, 4-75 CD player operation ..................................................
... 4-41 (models without color display) .................. ... 2-30
CD/USB memory care and cleaning ............ ... 4-75 Door open warning light .......................................
... 2-15
Center ventilators .......................................................
... 4-20 Draining water ...............................................................
... 8-13
Child restraint installation using ISOFIX ....... 1-18 Drive belt ............................................................................
... 8-14
10-2
Keys ............................................................................................
... 3-2 Meter Phone
For Intelligent Key system................................ ... 3-7 Trip computer (with color display) ......... ... 2-25 Bluetooth® Hands-Free
Trip computer (without Phone System ...........................
... 4-77, 4-83, 4-87
L color display) ............................................................
... 2-31 Power
Meters and gauges ........................................................
... 2-7 Auto slide back window system .............. ... 2-41
Labels Instrument brightness control .................. ... 2-10 Power outlet .............................................................
... 2-42
Air conditioner specification label........... ... 9-15 Mirror, Vanity mirror ..................................................
... 3-25 Power steering fluid ...........................................
... 8-18
Engine serial number ........................................
... 9-15 Power windows .....................................................
... 2-39
Vehicle Identification Number (VIN) ....... ... 9-14 N Pre-tensioner seat belt system......... ... 1-28, 1-34
Light Precautions
Bulb replacement .....................................
... 8-2, 8-26 New vehicle break-in ....................................................
... 5-3 Audio operation .....................................................
... 4-31
Fog light switch .....................................................
... 2-36 NISSAN Anti-Theft System (NATS*) key .......... ... 3-2 Cruise control ..........................................................
... 5-27
Headlight switch ...................................................
... 2-33 NissanConnect Owner’s Manual..........................
... 4-3 Driving safety ..............................................................
... 5-7
Headlights bulb replacement ..................... ... 8-26 Maintenance ................................................................
... 8-4
Indicator lights........................................................
... 2-17 O On-pavement and off-road driving .......... ... 5-7
Interior lights............................................................
... 2-47 Seat belt usage .........................................................
... 1-8
Map lights ...................................................................
... 2-47 Odometer...............................................................................
... 2-8 When starting and driving................................
... 5-3
Rear personal light ..............................................
... 2-48 Odometer (models with color display)........... ... 2-8 Push starting...................................................................
... 6-11
Replacement ................................................
... 8-2, 8-26 Odometer (models without Push-button ignition switch ...............................
... 5-10
Room light..................................................................
... 2-48 color display) .......................................................................
... 2-8
Warning/indicator lights and Oil R
audible reminders ................................................
... 2-14 Checking engine oil level...................................
... 8-9
Low fuel warning .........................................................
... 2-23 Engine oil........................................................................
... 8-9 Rear access doors (King Cab models)............ ... 3-5
Low fuel warning light ............................................
... 2-16 Oil and Filter replacement indicator ..... ... 2-25 Rear differential locking system ...................... ... 5-23
Oil control system.................................
... 2-29, 2-31 Rear door lock, Child safety rear
M Oil Filter replacement indicator ................ ... 2-25 door lock ................................................................................
... 3-5
Operating precautions ............................................
... 5-33 Rear fog light ..................................................................
... 2-37
Maintenance Operation Rear personal light .....................................................
... 2-48
Battery...............................................................
... 8-4, 8-21 Indicators for operation ..................................
... 2-21 Rear ventilators.............................................................
... 4-21
General maintenance...........................................
... 8-2 Outside air temperature .........................
... 2-30, 2-31 Rear view monitor ..........................................................
... 4-7
Maintenance precautions .................................
... 8-4 Overheat, If your vehicle overheats.............. ... 6-11 Remote controller battery....................................
... 8-22
Maintenance requirements ............................. ... 8-2 Remote keyless entry system ............................... ... 3-6
Seat belt maintenance.....................................
... 1-12 P Roof, Roof rack ..............................................................
... 2-45
Malfunction indicator light (MIL)...................... ... 2-18 Room light.........................................................................
... 2-48
Manual air conditioner Parking
and heater .........................................................
... 4-24, 4-26 Brake break-in ........................................................
... 5-35 S
Map light control switch........................................
... 2-47 Parking brake operation.................................
... 5-37
Map lights ..........................................................................
... 2-47 Parking sensor (sonar) function ......................... 4-18 Safety chains...................................................................
... 5-34
Master warning light.................................................
... 2-16 Parking sensor (sonar) system .........................
... 5-31 Safety, Child seat belts............................................
... 1-10
Maximum load limits.................................................
... 5-33 Seat
Mechanical key (Intelligent Key system) ....... ... 3-3 ISOFIX child restraint system ...................... ... 1-16
10-3
Seat adjustment, Front seats ................................ ... 1-2 Steering lock release Tire
Seat belt malfunction indicator........................................
... 2-22 Tire replacement indicator ........................... ... 2-25
Child restraint installation using Tilting steering wheel........................................
... 3-23 Tire recommendation for 4WD ........................ ... 5-22
three-point type seat belt ............................. ... 1-19 Sun visors ..........................................................................
... 2-46 Tires
Child restraint installation using Sunglasses holder.......................................................
... 2-44 Flat tire.............................................................................
... 6-2
two-point type seat belt................................. ... 1-23 Sunroof ................................................................................
... 2-41 Tire chains..................................................................
... 8-33
Seat belt(s) Automatic sunroof ..............................................
... 2-41 Tire pressure ............................................................
... 5-34
Child safety................................................................
... 1-10 Supplemental air bag systems Tire rotation ..................................................
... 8-3, 8-33
Injured persons ......................................................
... 1-11 Supplemental curtain side-impact air Types of tires ...........................................................
... 8-32
Pre-tensioner seat bag system ................................................................
... 1-31 Towing, Tow truck towing ...................................
... 6-12
belt system .................................................
... 1-28, 1-34 Supplemental driver’s knee air Trailer towing ..................................................
... 5-32, 5-33
Precautions on seat belt usage................... ... 1-8 bag system ................................................................
... 1-31 Transmission, Transmission shift lever
Pregnant women..................................................
... 1-10 Supplemental front-impact air lock release ......................................................................
... 5-16
Seat belt cleaning ...................................................
... 7-5 bag system ................................................................
... 1-31 Trip computer (with color display) ................ ... 2-25
Seat belt maintenance.....................................
... 1-12 Supplemental side-impact air Trip computer (without color display)........ ... 2-31
Seat belt warning light ....................................
... 2-17 bag system ................................................................
... 1-31 Trip odometer ................................................................
... 2-26
Seat belts .......................................................................
... 1-8 Supplemental curtain side-impact air Truck box ...........................................................................
... 3-19
Shoulder belt height adjustment ............ ... 1-11 bag system .......................................................................
... 1-25 Turbocharger system ..................................................
... 5-7
Seat(s) Supplemental driver’s knee air Turn signal switch ......................................................
... 2-35
Seats ..................................................................................
... 1-2 bag system .......................................................................
... 1-25
Servicing air conditioner........................................
... 4-30 Supplemental front-impact air U
Shift lever bag system .......................................................................
... 1-25
Shift lock release...................................................
... 5-16 Supplemental side-impact air Underbody cleaning ......................................................
... 7-3
Shift lock release bag system .......................................................................
... 1-25 Universal child restraints for rear seats ....... 1-14
Transmission ............................................................
... 5-16 Switch USB (Universal Serial Bus)
Shoulder belt height adjustment ................... ... 1-11 Fog light switch .....................................................
... 2-36 connection port ............................................................
... 4-74
Side ventilators..............................................................
... 4-20 Headlight aiming control ............................... ... 2-34 Using remote keyless entry system ................. ... 3-6
Smartphone integration ........................................
... 4-73 Headlight switch ...................................................
... 2-33
SOURCE select switch..............................................
... 4-76 Ignition switch ...........................................................
... 5-9 V
Spare tire............................................................................
... 8-34 Power door lock switch .....................................
... 3-5
Spark plugs.......................................................................
... 8-14 Turn signal switch ...............................................
... 2-35 Vanity mirror ...................................................................
... 3-25
Speedometer ......................................................................
... 2-8 Vanity mirror light.......................................................
... 2-48
SRS air bag deployment conditions............. ... 1-31 T Variable voltage control system ..................... ... 8-24
Starting Vehicle
Jump starting .............................................................
... 6-7 Tachometer..........................................................................
... 2-8 Dimensions ...................................................................
... 9-8
Precautions when starting Tailgate ................................................................................
... 3-19 Identification Number (VIN) .......................... ... 9-14
and driving....................................................................
... 5-3 Temperature gauge, Engine coolant Vehicle dynamic control
Push starting............................................................
... 6-11 temperature gauge .......................................................
... 2-9 (VDC) system ............................................................
... 5-23
Steering Three-way catalyst.........................................................
... 5-4 Vehicle information display (models with
Audio control steering switch .................... ... 4-75 Tie down hooks ............................................................
... 3-20 color display) ...................................................................
... 2-20
Power steering fluid ...........................................
... 8-18 Tilting steering wheel...............................................
... 3-23
Steering lock.............................................................
... 5-11
10-4
W
Warning
4WD warning ...........................................................
... 5-21
Lights..............................................................................
... 2-14
Vehicle information display
(models with color display)........................... ... 2-20
Vehicle information display
(models without color display) .................. ... 2-30
Warning lights, indicator lights and
audible reminders ................................................
... 2-13
Warning light
Anti-lock braking system (ABS)
warning light ............................................................
... 2-14
Brake warning light ............................................
... 2-14
Door open warning light ................................ ... 2-15
Low fuel warning light .....................................
... 2-16
Seat belt warning light ....................................
... 2-17
Washer switch, Windshield wiper and
washer switch ................................................................
... 2-37
Washing ...................................................................................
... 7-2
Waxing ......................................................................................
... 7-2
Wheels and tires
Care of wheels ...........................................................
... 7-3
Cleaning aluminum alloy wheels ................ ... 7-3
Tires and wheels .......................................
... 8-32, 9-7
Window washer fluid .....................................
... 8-4, 8-20
Window(s)
Auto slide back window system .............. ... 2-41
Cleaning ...............................................................
... 7-3, 7-4
Manual windows ...................................................
... 2-39
Power windows .....................................................
... 2-39
Windshield wiper and washer switch.......... ... 2-37
Wiper
Windshield wiper and
washer switch .........................................................
... 2-37
Wiper blades .............................................................
... 8-18
10-5
11 Epilogue
GAS STATION INFORMATION QUICK REFERENCE
D23A131129-CB8576A8-9B00-4E97-8E6F-F28C2AAD0786
D23A131129-E382FEC2-1FED-4E52-9FEF-5BE26C4BBF3C
. In case of emergency ... 6-1
FUEL INFORMATION
D23A131129-44C177D5-CB2E-4D61-8B94-23469B24487D
CAUTION: (Flat tire, engine will not start, overheating,
towing)
Gasoline engine (model with three-way . Do not use home heating oil, gasoline or
other alternate fuels in your diesel en- . How to start the engine ... 5-1
catalyst) . How to read the meters and gauges ... 2-1
GUID-E3E3F9FD-613E-441C-9E7E-201564761F81 gine. The use of those or adding those to
diesel fuel can cause engine damage. . Maintenance and do-it-yourself ... 8-1
CAUTION:
. Do not use summer fuel at temperatures . Technical information ... 9-1
Do not use leaded gasoline. Using leaded below −7°C (20°F). The cold temperatures
gasoline will damage the three-way catalyst. will cause wax to form in the fuel. As a
result, it may prevent the engine from
Use UNLEADED REGULAR gasoline with an running smoothly.
octane rating of at least 91 (RON).
For Thailand: Use UNLEADED REGULAR gasoline RECOMMENDED ENGINE OIL
D23A131129-BDE335F3-46F3-4207-AFAB-941D2F10193B
or gasohol (up to E10*) with an octane rating of
See “Recommended fluids/lubricants and ca-
at least 91 (RON).
pacities” (P.9-2).
*: Gasohol is alcohol blended gasoline. For
example, “E10” is a mixture of approximately TIRE COLD PRESSURE
D23A131129-9E3CE568-A19B-4D0F-A7DD-98A8DCE3CE42
10% fuel ethanol and 90% unleaded gasoline. See the tire placard affixed to the driver’s side
center pillar (Single Cab model and Double Cab
Diesel engine*
D23A131129-60E574A6-D3DA-4005-BA2D-E1F7281B4712 model) or the driver’s side rear access door
YD25DDTi engine: (King Cab model).
Diesel fuel above 50 cetane must be used.
YS23DDT/DDTT engine:
Diesel fuel above 50 cetane and with a max-
imum of 10 ppm of sulfur (EN590) must be used.
(except for South Africa)
Diesel fuel above 50 cetane and with a max-
imum of 50 ppm of sulfur (EN590) must be
used. (for South Africa)
* If two types of diesel fuel are available, use
summer or winter fuel properly according
to the following temperature conditions.
. Above −7°C (20°F) ... Summer type diesel
fuel.
. Below −7°C (20°F) ... Winter type diesel fuel.